我的世界1.6.2物品管理器(我的世界1.7.10nei物品管理器)
作者:佚名 来源:本站 时间:2025-02-12 点击:次
1. 我的世界1.7.10nei物品管理器
为什么这个幻灯片背景不能修改?如何取消幻灯片的自动播放?……这些问题经常被职场小白问起。这篇适合PPT小白快速入门的实用教程,目的是让读者学会、掌握、应用PPT,达到知其然并知其所以然。
了解PPT
初识PPT
PPT是Office办公组件中的一个软件。使用PPT创作的文件叫演示文稿,可以在投影仪或电脑上进行播放,也可将演示文稿打印出来,供他人浏览阅读。
一般情况下,大众喜爱的PPT通常都有一些相同的特点:内容准确清晰,版式简洁大方,动画则恰到好处。
1、内容准确清晰。PPT主要负责传递信息,所以需要严密的逻辑框架作为支撑。因此,通过看PPT的内容逻辑是否准确、清晰,就可以判断PPT是好还是坏。
2、版式简洁大方。PPT是用来传达观点的,所以不需要制作得太过复杂。一些初学者喜欢将各种各样的元素都放入PPT中,结果作品的效果却不尽如人意,观众也很难在杂乱无章的版式中获取演讲者所要表达的观点。
3、动画恰到好处。在PPT中恰到好处的动画会起到锦上添花的作用,多余复杂的动画则容易喧宾夺主。
了解PPT的结构
一、PPT的操作界面
PPT的操作界面主要包括标题栏、功能区、编辑区、文件菜单、视图区和状态栏。
1、标题栏。标题栏位于页面的最顶部,从左至右依次是快速访问工具栏、演示文稿名称、登录按钮、功能区显示选项按钮、最小化按钮、最大化按钮和关闭按钮。
2、功能区。功能区位于标题栏下方,默认包含8个选项卡,每个选项卡中包含多个选项组,相同类别的命令通常集中在同一个选项组中。同一个选项卡中包含的命令按钮也属于同一种类型。
下面详细介绍一下各选项卡的功能。
(1)“开始”选项卡。该选项卡中包括“剪贴板”“幻灯片”“字体”“段落”“绘图”和“编辑”6个选项组。在此,用户可以新建幻灯片,设置幻灯片的文本、段落以及样式等。
(2)“插入”选项卡。该选项卡包括“幻灯片”“表格”“图像”“插图”“加载项”“链接”“批注”“文本”“符号”及“媒体”选项组。在此,用户可以在幻灯片中插入各种表格、图片、超链接、文本框、公式、音像等元素。
(3)“设计”选项卡。该选项卡包括:“主题”“变体”“自定义”选项组。在此,用户可以对幻灯片的大小、背景格式等进行设置。
(4)“切换”选项卡。该选项卡包括“预览”“切换到此幻灯片”“计时”选项组。在此,用户可以为幻灯片设置各种切换效果。
(5)“动画”选项卡。该选项卡包括“预览”“动画”“高级动画”和“计时”选项组。在此,用户可以为其文本、图片等添加各种动画效果。
(6)“幻灯片放映”选项卡。该选项卡包括“开始放映幻灯片”“设置”“监视器”选项组。在此,用户可以对幻灯片的放映参数进行设置。
(7)“审阅”选项卡。该选项卡包括“校对”“语言”“比较”“墨迹”选项组。在此,用户可以对文字进行批注、检索、字体的简繁转换等。
(8)“视图”选项卡。该选项卡包括“演示文稿视图”“母版视图”“显示”“显示比例”“窗口”和“宏”选项组。在此,用户可以设置幻灯片的视图模式、显示标尺和网格线等。
3、编辑区。编辑区位于整个页面的中心位置,是演示文稿的工作区域。用户可以在编辑区内输入文字、插入图片、绘制图形等。编辑区的显示比例可以根据需要自由放大或缩小。
4、“文件”菜单。单击界面左上角的“文件”菜单按钮,可以打开“文件”菜单,该菜单中包含“信息”“新建”“打开”“保存”“另存为”“打印”“共享”“导出”“关闭”“帐户”等12个选项。
5、状态栏。状态栏位于界面最底部,从左到右依次显示的命令有“幻灯片页数”“当前显示页码”“拼写检索”按钮、“语言”“备注”按钮、“批注”按钮、“视图”按钮、“幻灯片放映”按钮、“视图缩放栏”等。
二、完整的PPT构成
一份完整的PPT包含5部分,分别为标题页、目录页、过渡页、内容页和结尾页,下面将分别对其进行详细介绍。
1、标题页。标题页决定观众的第一印象,如果标题页设计不好,则很难吸引观众的眼球。标题页可以是图片+文字的形式,也可以是纯文字形式。
(1)图片+文字。以图片为主的标题页,具有较强的感染力,如果再加上富有震撼力的标题文字,那就更容易吸引观众的视线了。这种形式的标题页需要注意的一个问题是所选的图片一定要是高清图片。
(2)纯文字。纯文字的标题页,需要考虑排版问题。建议初学者尽量不要尝试。有时为了避免页面版式空洞,可以适当添加一些形状来修饰。
2、目录页。一般情况下,目录页紧随标题页之后。目录页可让观众了解PPT的大致内容。目录页的表现形式有多种,下面将分别对其进行介绍。
(1)利用形状。目录页简洁明了,能突出重点即可,所以使用形状是不错的选择。
(2)利用PNG图标。使用图标,可以帮助观众更好地记忆内容,并且看起来简洁清爽,不会喧宾夺主。
(3)利用图片。将目录与图片结合起来,能有效打破页面的平淡无奇,给人眼前一亮的感觉。
3、过渡页。如果PPT的页数较多,可以在其中添加过渡页,这样可以给观众一个短暂的休息时间。当然如果PPT的页数较少,就没有必要添加了,可以根据实际情况而定。
4、内容页。内容页是整个PPT中必不可少的,也是最重要的一部分,多以图文结合的页面形式来传达内容。
5、结尾页。结束页可以写一些激励性或感谢性的文字,或是表达美好祝愿的话语。同时要注意与PPT的整体风格相呼应。
三、PPT与幻灯片的关系
PPT又叫演示文稿,格式后缀为.ppt、.pptx。演示文稿中的每一页就叫幻灯片,每张幻灯片都是演示文稿中既相互独立又相互联系的内容。
PPT的基本操作
对PPT结构有所了解后,接下来就要了解一下PPT的基本操作了。PPT的基本操作包括创建演示文稿、保存演示文稿、打开和关闭演示文稿、查看演示文稿等,下面分别对其进行详细介绍。
1、轻松创建文稿
创建PPT的方法有多种,下面以创建模板PPT为例,向用户介绍具体的操作方法。
步骤1:双击PowerPoint应用程序快捷图标,启动软件,在打开界面右侧的搜索框中输入需要搜索模板的类型,然后单击“开始搜索”按钮。
步骤2:随即在新建界面中显示出所有搜索到的模板,单击选择需要的模板。
步骤3:弹出模板详情窗口,接着单击“创建”按钮。
步骤4:系统开始下载该模板,下载完成后会自动打开该模板,即可创建一个模板PPT。
2、保存与另存为
在创建演示文稿后,需要将其保存,以免因为意外断电或电脑死机,而造成文件内容丢失。在创建演示文稿后,如果用户是第一次执行保存操作,则可以按照以下方法进行保存。
步骤1:在演示文稿界面,单击“文件”菜单按钮。
步骤2:在打开的“文件”菜单窗口中选择“另存为”选项,在右侧选择“浏览”选项。
步骤3:打开“另存为”对话框,从中选择保存的位置,修改“文件名”,单击“保存”按钮。
步骤4:返回演示文稿,此时可以看到,标题栏中即显示修改后的演示文稿的名称。当用户执行保存操作后,若对演示文稿进行了修改和编辑,直接单击“保存”按钮即可对其保存。
3、打开与关闭操作
打开演示文稿的操作方法其实很简单,除了双击文件图标外,还可以按照以下几种方法进行操作。
(1)右键打开法。打开文件所在的文件夹,单击选中需要打开的演示文稿,然后单击鼠标右键,从弹出的快捷菜单中选择“打开”命令,即可打开所选的演示文稿。
(2)打开计算机中的演示文稿。还可以利用已打开的演示文稿选择计算机中的其他演示文稿,具体操作如下:
步骤1:在打开的演示文稿中单击“文件”菜单按钮。(也可以通过Ctrl+O快捷键打开计算机中的演示文稿,这种方法更加方便快捷。)
步骤2:进入“文件”菜单,选择“打开”选项,并在右侧选择“浏览”选项。
步骤3:弹出“打开”对话框,选中需要打开的演示文稿,然后单击“打开”按钮,即可打开选中的演示文稿。
4、查看演示文稿
在制作完演示文稿后,为了确保内容的准确性,可以对演示文稿中的内容进行查看。
(1)普通视图。在普通视图下,将光标移到编辑区上方,滑动鼠标滚轮可以对幻灯片的内容进行查看,或者将光标放在右侧的滑块上,拖动鼠标查看PPT中的内容。
(2)幻灯片浏览。在状态栏中单击“幻灯片浏览”按钮,可在浏览模式中对演示文稿中所有幻灯片进行查看。
(3)阅读视图。在状态栏中单击“阅读视图”按钮,即可进入放映预览状态,在这种状态下,用户可以对幻灯片中的内容和动画效果进行查看。
幻灯片的基本操作
前面介绍了演示文稿的基本操作,接下来学习一下幻灯片的基本操作,包括选择幻灯片、新建幻灯片、移动与复制幻灯片、隐藏与删除幻灯片、更改幻灯片的背景等。
一、选择幻灯片
1、选择单个幻灯片。如果想选择单个幻灯片,则只需在预览区域单击所需幻灯片,即可将其选中。
2、选择不连续的幻灯片。按住Ctrl键不放,在预览区域中依次用鼠标单击多个幻灯片,即可将不连续的幻灯片选中。
3、选择连续的幻灯片。按住Shift键,在预览区域中单击任意两个不相邻的幻灯片,即可将它们之间的所有幻灯片选中。
4、选择全部幻灯片。首先单击预览区域中任意幻灯片,然后按Ctrl+A组合键,即可将全部幻灯片选中。
二、新建幻灯片
若演示文稿中的幻灯片太少,不能满足编辑需求,则用户可以在演示文稿中新建幻灯片。
步骤1:打开演示文稿,选中任意一张幻灯片,在“开始”选项卡中单击“新建幻灯片”下拉按钮,从列表中选择“空白”选项。
步骤2:被选中的幻灯片下方随即新建一个“空白”版式的幻灯片。
步骤3:若在下拉列表中选择“两栏内容”选项。
步骤4:即可新建“两栏内容”版式的幻灯片。
注:还可以通过右键菜单功能来新建幻灯片,即选择任意幻灯片,单击鼠标右键,从弹出的快捷菜单中选择“新建幻灯片”命令,即可新建—个幻灯片。
三、移动与复制幻灯片
在编辑演示文稿的过程中,如果觉得幻灯片的顺序不合理,可以移动幻灯片来调整其顺序。若需要添加相同格式的幻灯片,则可以复制幻灯片,下面将介绍几种移动与复制幻灯片的方法。
1、移动幻灯片。可以按照以下几种方法移动幻灯片:
(1)功能区按钮移动
步骤1:选择需要移动的幻灯片,在“开始”选项卡中单击“剪切”按钮。
步骤2:将光标定位至需要移动到的位置,单击“粘贴”下拉按钮,从列表中选择“使用目标主题”选项。
步骤3:随即将所选幻灯片移动到目标位置。
(2)鼠标拖动移动
步骤1:选择需要的幻灯片,然后按住鼠标左键不放,拖动鼠标至合适位置。
步骤2:释放鼠标左键,即可完成幻灯片的移动。
2、复制幻灯片
若用户想要添加相同格式的幻灯片,则可以利用复制功能来实现,下面介绍几种复制幻灯片的方法。
(1)功能区按钮复制
步骤1:选择需要复制的幻灯片,在“开始”选项卡中单击“复制”按钮。
步骤2:在需要粘贴的位置插入光标,单击“粘贴”下拉按钮,从列表中选择“使用目标主题”选项即可。
步骤3:此时在该位置可显示所复制的幻灯片。
(2)右键快捷菜单复制
选择幻灯片后,单击鼠标右键,从弹出的快捷菜单中选择“复制幻灯片”命令即可。
(3)鼠标+键盘复制
选择需要复制的幻灯片,并按住鼠标左键不放,接着在键盘上按住Ctrl键,然后拖动鼠标至合适位置,释放鼠标左键后松开Ctrl键,即可复制选择的幻灯片。
四、隐藏与显示幻灯片
如果不想播放某张幻灯片,但又不想将其删除,则可以将该幻灯片隐藏起来。
步骤1:选择需要隐藏的幻灯片,这里选择第2张幻灯片,切换至“幻灯片放映”选项卡,单击“隐藏幻灯片”按钮。
步骤2:此时,可以看到所选幻灯片的左上角出现了隐藏符号。如果想要显示隐藏的幻灯片,则需要再次单击“隐藏幻灯片”按钮,即可将隐藏的幻灯片显示出来。
注:还可以通过右键菜单来隐藏幻灯片,即选择需要隐藏的幻灯片,单击鼠标右键,从弹出的快捷菜单中选择“隐藏幻灯片”命令,即可将选择的幻灯片隐藏起来。
五、删除幻灯片
当演示文稿中的幻灯片较多,有些内容多余,想精减时,可以将冗余的幻灯片删除。下面介绍两种删除幻灯片的方法。
1、右键菜单法。选择需要删除的幻灯片,然后单击鼠标右键,从弹出的快捷菜单中选择“删除幻灯片”命令,即可将选择的幻灯片删除。
2、快捷键法。选择需要删除的幻灯片,然后直接在键盘上按Delete键,即可将所选幻灯片删除。
六、调整幻灯片大小
默认的幻灯片大小为宽屏(16:9),用户也可以根据需要自定义幻灯片的大小,下面介绍具体的操作方法。
步骤1:选择幻灯片,切换至“设计”选项卡,单击“幻灯片大小”下拉按钮,从中选择“自定义幻灯片大小”选项。
步骤2:打开“幻灯片大小”对话框,在“幻灯片大小”下拉列表中选择“自定义”选项,设置“宽度”和“高度”值,单击“确定”按钮。
步骤3:弹出相应的对话框,从中选择“确保适合”选项。
步骤4:此时,可以看到幻灯片的尺寸随即被调整为自定义的大小。
注:也可以直接在“幻灯片大小”下拉列表中选择“标准”选项,快速更改幻灯片的大小。
七、更改幻灯片的背景
如果对当前幻灯片的背景不满意,可以对其进行更改。具体操作方法如下:
步骤1:选择幻灯片,在“设计”选项卡中单击“设置背景格式”按钮。
步骤2:弹出“设置背景格式”窗格,切换至“填充”选项卡,在“填充”组中选中“图片或纹理填充”单选按钮,接着单击下方的“文件”按钮。
步骤3:打开“插入图片”对话框,选择图片后单击“插入”按钮。
步骤4:关闭窗格,此时可以看到幻灯片的背景更改为图片背景的效果了。
版式设计
了解PPT的基本操作后,用户可以制作出简单的演示文稿,但如果想制作出精美大气的作品,则需要对版式进行一番设计。本节将对PPT的版式设计、模板的运用、PPT的配色等进行全面介绍。
PPT版式设计原则
一、什么样的页面版式才好看
好看的页面版式会遵循亲近、对比、对齐和重复这4项原则。
1、亲近
内容上有关联的要靠近,没有关联的要远离,同时要统一各段落的间隔。
2、对齐
各层之间要对齐,因为每一个元素都与页面上的某项内容存在某种视觉联系,如果随意安放,则会显得混乱。但页面中有很多个关键字时,打破对齐也能产生不一样的视觉效果。
3、对比
对比的方法有3种:文字对比、颜色对比和图形对比。通过对比可以迅速吸引观众的眼球。
下图则通过图形色块来区分各项内容。当观众看到这张幻灯片内容时,会立即被黄色色块的内容吸引住。这里需要提醒一点的是,对比的力度一定要大,否则就不要用。
4、重复
通过让PPT的部分元素,例如图片、字体、配色等重复使用,可以使PPT的版式风格统一,避免杂乱无章。但需要注意的是,不要一味地单调重复,要明确每个页面的作用。
(1)标题页
(2)目录页
(3)内容页
(4)结尾页
二、PPT中的留白艺术
留白留出的是空间。对于幻灯片而言,最直观的好处就是用户可以轻易地添加文字,保证文字信息不受干扰,和图片一起传递信息。另外,留白具有与生俱来的雅致、高端、文艺、轻盈、简约气质。下面就向读者介绍在PPT中人为留白的3种方法。
1、寻找简单的背景图。尽量用简单的图片作为幻灯片背景,然后添加与主题相关的关键字即可。当然寻找的图片也应当与主题相关才行。
2、利用形状衬托关键字。利用精致的图片作为背景,使用矩形覆盖背景某区域,以作为文字的底衬,在矩形框中输入文字即可。该矩形框可填充颜色,也可提高它的透明度。
3、减少页面信息量。留出空白其实就是做减法。减去多余的,留出关键的信息即可。
三、页面排版的4大利器
想要实现以上4项排版原则,则需要利用以下4种辅助工具来操作。
1、对齐。PPT为用户提供了8种对齐方式。通过使用这些对齐方式,用户可以快速完成页面的布局,提高PPT排版效率,对齐的操作方法如下::
步骤1:选择需对齐的元素,这里选择文本,切换至“绘图工具-格式”选项卡,单击“对齐”下拉按钮,从列表中选择“垂直居中”选项。
步骤2:此时可以看到,选中的文本已经显示为垂直居中。
步骤3:若在列表中选择“右对齐”选项,则选中的文本将向右对齐显示。
2、组合。将多个对象组合在一起后,可以实现整体的快速移动,当缩小或放大形状组合时,组合中的所有形状的大小会同时发生改变,具体操作方法如下:
步骤1:选中图形对象,单击鼠标右键,从弹出的快捷菜单中选择“组合”选项。
步骤2:将形状组合在一起后,按住Shift键不放,可以等比例放大或缩小图形。
3、窗格。窗格可以通过单击“绘图工具-格式”选项卡中的“选择窗格”按钮打开,窗格的作用是调节各个元素的层次,对此也可以通过鼠标拖动来实现,还可以通过单击按钮实现。此外,通过窗格还可以隐藏元素,单击右侧的眼睛图标即可隐藏。
4、网格与参考线。网格和参考线一般用来定位PPT中的各元素。两者都是在编辑状态下显示,播放幻灯片时则会自动隐藏。
如果需要调出网格或参考线的话,只需要在“视图”选项卡中勾选“网格”或“参考线”选项即可。这两个选项卡可以同时勾选,也可以只勾选其中一项。在对页面进行排版时,只需勾选“参考线”这一项即可。在勾选参考线后,系统会在页面中心位置分别显示水平和垂直两条参考线。
需要添加参考线的话,只需将光标放置在参考线上,当光标变成双向箭头时,点击鼠标右键,在弹出的快捷菜单中根据需要选择“添加垂直参考线”或“添加水平参考线”选项即可。也可以为参考线更换颜色。同样在参考线上点击鼠标右键,在快捷菜单中选择“颜色”选项,并在打开的级联菜单中选择一种颜色即可。
如果想要删除参考线,只需在“视图”选项卡中,取消勾选“参考线”选项即可。也可以在参考线上单击鼠标右键,在快捷菜单中选择“删除”选项,即可删除多余参考线。
用好PPT模板
如果用户觉得自己制作模板比较耗时,则可套用网上下载的模板,或者对现有模板进行修改,符合要求后再使用。
一、如何挑选模板
网上有大量的模板,其中不乏精品,但选择模板时,一定要挑选合适的模板。这里将介绍挑选模板的3个原则。
1、符合公司形象。如果用户展示的演示文稿代表整个公司,那么选择的模板一定要符合公司的形象。一般会选择严肃、大方的模板。
2、契合展示主题。选择模板时要符合展示的主题,不同的主题对模板的要求不一样。例如,如果主题是关于儿童教育的,就尽量用卡通类的,或者各种手绘风格的模板。
3、让人眼前一亮。用户制作PPT除了辅助演讲外,最重要的是吸引观众的注意力,所以制作的PPT要有特色,看起来让人赏心悦目,这样才能让人眼前一亮。
注:可以通过PPT论坛、共享网站、PPT商店、PPT模板下载网站以及达人的博客或微博下载需要的PPT模板。需要提醒一点的是,下载模板时需弄清楚该模板是否可以商用。很多模板都存在版权问题,用户私下交流没有关系,一旦涉及商用,就需缴纳一定的版权费了。
二、对模板进行微调
一般情况下,模板下载完以后,都需要对其调整,毕竟没有百分之百合适的模板。当用户需要对模板进行调整时,可以分3步操作:删除、改变和添加。
1、删除多余页面或元素。删除模板中一些多余的页面,因为有些页面只是版面设计不同,而内容是相同的,像这些页面就需要删除。
2、改变。可以改变幻灯片的大小、背景图、配色、字体和版式设计等。首先,可以修改以下幻灯片的版式设计。其次,可以将标题幻灯片中的文字进行修改,例如修改其文字内容、字体或字号等。
3、添加。如果现有的版式不能完全满足需求,则可以另外添加一页版式。用户只需根据自己的需求简单调整即可。这样做出来的PPT既快又好。想高效制作PPT,使用模板是最佳的选择。
三、认识幻灯片的母版
使用母版最大的好处在于,它可以快速统一幻灯片的风格,例如文字、图片、背景等。下面将详细介绍母版的结构和类型。
步骤1:打开演示文稿,切换至“视图”选项卡,单击“幻灯片母版”按钮。
步骤2:进入母版视图后,在左侧可以看到一组默认的母版结构。
步骤3:Office主题。该页位于母版视图的首位,也称之为母版页。在这一页中添加的内容会出现在以下所有版式页中。
注:母版视图是由母版页和版式页这两个部分组成的。母版页仅为第1张幻灯片,除此之外,所有的幻灯片都称为版式页。
步骤4:标题幻灯片。可用于幻灯片的封面、封底设计。与母版页不同时,需要勾选隐藏背景图形复选框。
步骤5:标题和内容。由标题框架和内容框架部分组成。
步骤6:此外,还有节标题、两栏内容、比较、仅标题、空白、内容与标题版式等。这些版式都可以根据设计需要重新调整。
四、修改幻灯片的母版
用户可以在幻灯片母版中修改字体和版式,使幻灯片形成统一的风格。具体操作步骤介绍如下:
步骤1:打开演示文稿,切换至“视图”选项卡,单击“幻灯片母版”按钮。
步骤2:进入母版视图模式,然后选择Office主题母版,并选中其中的标题占位符。
步骤3:切换至“开始”选项卡,单击“字体”下拉按钮,从列表中选择“汉仪行楷简”选项。
步骤4:单击“字号”下拉按钮,从列表中选择“40”。
步骤5:按照同样的方法,设置文本占位符中的字体、字号。
步骤6:切换至“幻灯片母版”选项卡,单击“背景样式”下拉按钮,从列表中选择“设置背景格式”选项。
步骤7:打开“设置背景格式”窗格,切换至“填充”选项卡,在“填充”组中选中“图片或纹理填充”单选按钮,并单击“文件”按钮。
步骤8:打开“插入图片”对话框,从中选择背景图片后单击“插入”按钮。
步骤9:关闭窗格,切换至“插入”选项卡,单击“图片”按钮。
步骤10:打开“插入图片”对话框,选择图片后单击“插入”按钮。
步骤11:将图片插入到母版中,调整图片的大小,将其移至页面合适位置。
步骤12:按照同样的方法,插入另外—张图片,然后将其移至合适位置。
步骤13:选中标题幻灯片,在“背景”选项组中勾选“隐藏背景图形”复选框。
步骤14:隐藏图形后,为其填充背景图片。在“插入”选项卡中单击“图片”按钮。
步骤15:打开“插入图片”对话框,选择图片后单击“插入”按钮。
步骤16:插入图片后调整图片的大小,并将其移至页面合适位置。
步骤17:单击“幻灯片母版”选项卡中的“关闭母版视图”按钮,查看设置的效果。
用好的配色装扮PPT
PPT中的颜色很重要,一个页面色彩靓丽且配色舒适的PPT很容易就能抓往观众的眼球。当然也不能胡乱的运用色彩,下面将介绍关于配色方面的知识,为设计PPT的版式打好基础。
一、几种安全配色模式
1、灰底单色搭配。使用灰色作为背景色,和其他单一颜色进行搭配。灰色可以营造出精致、含蓄的氛围。
2、白底单色搭配。白色是百搭色,使用白色作为背景色,可以和任意颜色进行搭配。白色给人一种清爽、干净的感觉。
3、同色系明暗搭配。尝试使用同一种色相、不同明度的颜色进行搭配。这种方法比较简单和安全。
4、只用单一背景色。有时使用单一的背景色加上几个关键字或图片,也能起到很好的效果。
二、取色器的使用秘诀
使用取色器可以将其他PPT中的配色提取并运用到自己的PPT中,也可以从图片中快速提取出需要的颜色。下面将为大家介绍具体的操作方法:
步骤1:选中需要填充颜色的图形,切换至“绘图工具-格式”选项卡,单击“形状填充”下拉按钮,从列表中选择“取色器”选项。
步骤2:此时,鼠标光标变为吸管形状,将它移动到想要填充的色块上,在吸管右侧会显示该色块的色值。
步骤3:确认后单击鼠标左键,即可将选取的颜色快速填充到图形中。
注:在电脑系统中,R、G、B分别代表着红色、绿色和蓝色,这3种颜色的值均用0-255的整数来表示。例如,纯红色的色值为(255,0,0),纯绿色的色值为(0.255,0),而纯蓝色的色值为(0.,0.255)。用户只要在“颜色”对话框的“颜色模式”选项组下设置这些色值参数即可,在默认情况下“颜色模式”为“RGB“。
学会运用PPT主题
前面介绍了创建模板演示文稿,其实使用主题创建演示文稿也是一种不错的选择,这样可以免去用户自己设计主题的麻烦。
一、使用主题创建PPT
使用主题创建演示文稿的方法和创建模板演示文稿相似,具体的操作步骤如下:
步骤1:启动PowerPoint,在打开界面的右侧单击“主题”按钮。
步骤2:在搜索到的主题中选择合适的选项。
步骤3:单击该选项,将弹出一个窗格,然后直接单击“创建”按钮。
步骤4:系统开始下载该主题演示文稿,下载完成后会自动打开演示文稿。
二、修改主题样式
如果对默认的主题样式不满意,可以对主题的颜色、字体、背景等进行修改,下面介绍具体的操作方法:
步骤1:修改主题颜色。切换至“设计”选项卡,单击“变体”选项组中的“其他”按钮,从列表中选择“颜色”选项,并从其级联菜单中选择合适的颜色。
步骤2:修改主题字体。单击“变体”选项组中的“其他”按钮,从列表中选择“字体”选项,并从其级联菜单中选择合适的字体。
步骤3:修改主题背景样式。单击“变体”选项组中的“其他”按钮,从列表中选择“背景样式”选项,并从其级联菜单中选择“设置背景格式”选项。
步骤4:修改主题背景样式。单击“变体”选项组中的“其他”按钮,从列表中选择“背景样式”选项,并从其级联菜单中选择“设置背景格式”选项。
步骤5:在“设置背景格式”窗格中单击“应用到全部”按钮。
步骤6:单击“关闭”按钮,关闭窗格,查看修改主题背景样式的效果。(注:可以在“设计”选项卡中单击“主题”选项组中的“其他”按钮,从列表中可以直接更改当前演示文稿的主题。)
主题模板与模板的区别:主题模板可以统一更改颜色、背景,而模板则不可以。
字体搭配
制作演示文稿的目的是为了展示内容,传达观点,所以文本是演示文稿中不可或缺的,并且在幻灯片中输入文本后还要对其进行各种设置。本节将对文字的选择、文本的输入、文本的编辑、文本段落的设置等操作进行全面介绍。
文字的选择有讲究
字体是演示文稿中必不可少的一个元素,要想制作出优秀的演示文稿,选择一种合适的字体很重要。
一、选择合适的字体
一般用户会使用PPT中默认的字体,这样制作出来的PPT看起来千篇一律。其实选择一种合适的字体,会起到不—样的效果,用户可以根据不同场合使用不同的字体。
1、普通字体。PPT中用到的绝大多数字体都可归为普通字体。例如,微软雅黑、黑体、华文行楷、汉仪系列等,目前大多数的PPT都经常使用这类字体。
2、钢笔字体。在PPT中使用钢笔字体,例如方正硬笔行书简体、方正硬笔楷书简体等,可以使PPT充满文艺感。这类字体比较适合教育、书籍、文化等领域相关主题内容。
3、书法字体。书法字体很常见,例如日本青柳衡山毛笔字体、段宁毛笔行书、叶根友系列字体等,这类字体适合中国风、水墨风的PPT。
4、卡通字体。卡通字体在视觉上非常可爱,例如华康娃娃体、方正卡通简体、方正胖头鱼简体、汉仪乐窑体等,这类字体适合儿童教学课件或与儿童相关的主题。
5、英文字体。前面几种类型均为中文字体,但在制作PPT时还会用到英文,那英文字体该怎么选呢?这里将推荐几款常用英文字体,供用户参考。
(1)TimesNewRoman。该字体是系统自带的英文字体,适合历史文化类PPT。
(2)Tahoma。该字体也是系统自带的字体,给人一种亲切感,在一定程度上可以调节现场氛围。
(3)SegoeUILight。该字体比较纤细,使用该字体可以使整个PPT看起来清新自然。
(4)PalaceScriptMT。该字体是装饰性很强的手写体,一般用于文艺、请帖、节日等主题。
提示:在一张幻灯片中,如果中英文同时存在,那么英文字体就要根据中文字体来调整,也就是说两种字体要相互匹配。另外,字体也有版权如果用户将下载的字体用于商业用途,则需要支付版权费。
二、安装字体的方法
如果用户在网上下载了几款字体,想要进行安装,可以按照以下几种方法进行操作:
1、复制和粘贴字体。可以全选需要安装的字体,然后按Ctrl+C组合键进行复制操作,再按照相应的路径(C:iWindowsl)找到“Fonts”文件夹,打开该文件夹,按Ctrl+V组合键,将复制的字体进行粘贴即可。
2、“安装”字体。首先选择需要安装的字体,然后单击鼠标右键,从弹出的快捷菜单中选择“安装”命令即可安装。此外,还可以双击要安装的字体文件,在打开的字体对话框中单击“安装”按钮即可。
3、使用快捷方式安装字体。在需要安装大批量的字体时,为了防止占用系统磁盘空间,影响软件的运行速度,可以使用快捷方式来安装字体,具体操作方法如下:
步骤1:根据路径(C:iWindowslFonts)打开“Fonts”文件夹,单击左侧的“字体设置”选项按钮。
步骤2:在打开的“字体设置”界面中,勾选“允许使用快捷方式安装字体(高级)”复选框,单击“确定”按钮,关闭该界面。
步骤3:打开要安装的字体文件夹,全选字体,单击鼠标右键,从弹出的快捷菜单中选择“作为快捷方式安装”选项即可。
根据内容输入文本
制作演示文稿时需要在其中输入文本,然后设置文本的字体、字号、字符间距、文本的特殊效果等操作。
一、输入文本。想要在幻灯片中输入文本,则需要占位符和文本框做载体。介绍两种常见的文本输入方法:
1、在占位符中输入文本。幻灯片中的占位符由幻灯片的版式决定,用户可以直接在占位符中输入文本,具体的操作步骤如下:
步骤1:打开演示文稿,将光标定位至需要输入文本的占位符中。
步骤2:选择合适的输入法,直接在占位符中输入文本即可。
2、在文本框中输入文本。需要在幻灯片中添加文本框,然后才能输入文本,具体操作方法如下:
步骤1:切换至“插入”选项卡,在“文本”选项组中单击“文本框”下拉按钮,在展开的列表中选择“绘制横排文本框”选项。
步骤2:鼠标光标变为十字形状,按住鼠标左键不放,在页面合适位置拖动鼠标绘制文本框。
步骤3:绘制好后松开鼠标,此时幻灯片中出现一个虚线框,即为文本框,并且光标自动定位至文本框中。
步骤4:在文本框中直接输入文字即可。
二、调整字体字号
在幻灯片中输入文本后,可以对文本的字体、字号进行设置,具体的操作方法如下:
步骤1:调整字体。选择需要调整字体的文本框,然后在“开始”选项卡中单击“字体”下拉按钮。
步骤2:从展开的下拉列表中选择“汉仪行楷简”选项。
步骤3:按照同样的方法设置其他文本的字体,查看设置的效果。
步骤4:调整字号。选择需要调整字号的文本框,在“字号”文本框中输入“80”。
步骤5:按Enter键确认输入。按照同样的方法设置其他文本的字号。
提示:可以选择需要设置颜色的文本,在“开始”选项卡中单击“字体颜色”下拉按钮,从列表中选择合适的颜色,即可为所选文本设置颜色。
三、应用文本特殊效果
如果用户想要文本特殊显示,可以为其设置加粗、倾斜、阴影、下划线等效果,下面将介绍具体的操作方法:
步骤1:加粗。选择需要加粗的文本,在“开台”选项卡中单击“加粗”按钮即可使文本加粗显示。
步骤2:倾斜。选择文本,在“开始”选项卡中单击“倾斜”按钮,即可将文本变倾斜。
步骤3:阴影。选择文本,在“开始”选项卡中单击“文字阴影”按钮。
步骤4:下划线。选择文本,在“开始”选项卡中单击“下划线”按钮。
步骤5:如果用户想要清除设置的效果,则可以单击“清除所有格式”按钮,可以将所设置的格式效果清除。
编辑输入的文本
在幻灯片中输入文本后,通常还需要对其进行各种编辑,这时就会涉及到对文本的一些基础操作,例如选取文本、移动与复制文本、查找和替换等。
一、选取文本
1、选择连续的文本。只需要将光标定位至需要选择文本的开始位置,然后按住鼠标左键不放,拖动鼠标至需要选择文本的结束位置,释放鼠标左键即可。此外,用户也可以将光标定位至需要选择文本的开始位置,然后按住Shift键不放,单击选择文本的结束处,即可将开始到结束处的这段文本内容全部选中。
2、选择单个词语。需要将光标定位至某个词语的任意位置,然后双击鼠标,即可将该词语选中。还可以将光标定位至词语的开始位置,然后按住鼠标左键不放,拖动鼠标至词语的结束位置,释放鼠标左键,即可将该词语选中。
3、选择段落。在选择段落的任意位置处连续单击3次鼠标左键,即可将该段落选中。
4、选择多处不连续的区域。在文档中先使用拖动鼠标的方法选择一个文本,然后按住Ctrl键不放,依次选择其他文本,这样就可以将多个不连续的区域选中。
5、选择全部文本。使用快捷键全选文本,只需将光标定位至文本中任意位置,然后按Ctrl+A组合键,即可将文本全部选中。
二、移动和复制文本
用户使用移动与复制命令,可以减少重复文本的录入,提高工作效率。
1、移动文本。可以使用“剪切”命令移动文本,操作如下:
步骤1:选中需要移动的文本,在“开始”选项卡中单击“剪切”按钮。
步骤2:选择需要粘贴文本的幻灯片,然后在“开始”选项卡中单击“粘贴”按钮,文本随即被移动到该幻灯片中。
步骤3:选中文本,然后按住鼠标左键不放,拖动鼠标,即可将其移至幻灯片页面合适位置。
提示:使用快捷键Ctrl+X剪切文本,然后使用Ctrl+V粘贴文本,也可以移动文本。
2、复制文本。复制文本是将所选内容复制到剪贴板,然后粘贴到其他位置,具体操作方法如下:
步骤1:选择需要复制的文本,然后在“开始”选项卡中单击“复制”按钮。
步骤2:选择需要粘贴的幻灯片,单击“粘贴”按钮,即可复制选择的文本。
提示:用户也可以选择需要复制的文本,按Ctrl+D组合键进行复制。
三、查找与替换文本
当演示文稿中出现大量的错误文本时,为了节省时间,可以使用查找和替换功能进行更改,下面将介绍具体的操作方法:
1、查找文本。首先要将错误的文本查找出来,具体操作方法如下:
步骤1:打开演示文稿,在“开始”选项卡中单击“编辑”选项组的“查找”按钮。
步骤2:打开“查找”对话框,在“查找内容”文本框中输入要查找的文本,这里输入“想要查找的文本内容”,然后单击“查找下一个”按钮。
步骤3:此时,查找到的文本处于选中状态,用户可以确认是否属于录入错误。
步骤4:继续单击“查找下一个”按钮,当查找到最后一个文本时,会弹出提示对话框,提示用户已经查找到最后一个匹配项目,单击“确定”按钮,关闭“查找”对话框即可。
2、替换文本。用户可以逐一替换错误的文本,也可以全部替换,具体的操作方法如下:
步骤1:在“开始”选项卡中单击“编辑”选项组的“替换”按钮。
步骤2:打开“替换”对话框,在“查找内容”文本框中输入要查找的文本,然后在“替换为”文本框中输入要替换的文本,单击“查找下一个”按钮。
步骤3:系统随即查找到相匹配的文本,接着单击“替换”按钮,即可将文本进行替换。
步骤4:如果单击“全部替换”按钮,可以一次性将查找到的文本全部替换。
设置文本段落
在幻灯片中输入文本内容后需要对其设置段落格式,这样整个页面才能更加美观,段落格式的设置包括设置段落对齐方式、行及段落间距等。
一、设置段落对齐方式
段落对齐方式是指段落对齐到文本框的方式,包括水平对齐和垂直对齐。下面将介绍如何设置段落的水平对齐方式。
步骤1:选中需要设置对齐方式的文本,在“开始”选项卡中单击“居中”按钮。
步骤2:此外,用户还可以在“开始”选项卡中单击“对齐文本”下拉按钮,从列表中选择所需的垂直对齐方式。
二、设置行间距及段落间距
如果一个文本框中包含多个行和段落,为其置合适的行和段落间距,可以使整个幻灯片页看起来更加舒适、美观,下面将介绍如何设置子及段落间距。
1、设置行距。行距是指每一行文字之间的距离,设置行距的操作方法如下:
步骤1:选中要设置行距的文本,在“开始”选页卡中单击“行距”下拉按钮。
步骤2:对选中的文本各行之间的间距进行相应的调整。
2、设置段落间距。段落间距是指段落与段落之间的距离,可以设置段前和段后的距离,具体操作方法如下:
步骤1:选择需要设置段落间距的文本,在“开始”选项卡中单击“段落”选项组的对话框启动器按钮。
步骤2:打开“段落”对话框,在“缩进和间距”选项卡中设置“段前”、“段后”间距,设置完成后单击“确定”按钮。
三、添加项目符号及编号
为文本添加项目符号或编号可使文本内容更有条理性,下面讲解如何添加项目符号及编号。
步骤1:添加项目符号。选中需要添加项目符号的文本,在“开始”选项卡中单击“项目符号”下拉按钮,从列表中选择合适的项目符号,这里选择“带填充效果的钻石形项目符号”选项。
步骤2:可以看到选中的文本随即被添加了项目符号。
四、设置文本分栏
步骤1:选择需要分栏的文本,在“开始”选项卡中单击“添加或删除栏”下拉按钮。
步骤2:从展开的列表中选择“更多栏”选项。
步骤3:打开“栏”对话框,在“数量”微调框中输入数值“3”,在“间距”微调框中输入数值“0.5”,设置完成后单击“确定”按钮。
步骤4:文本随即被分成3栏,并按照设置调整了各栏之间的间距。
艺术字的妙用
在制作幻灯片时使用艺术字可以快速抓住观众的眼球,而且外观多变的艺术字还能为幻灯片增加活泼生动的气息。
步骤1:打开演示文稿,切换至“插入”选项卡,单击“文本”选项组中的“艺术字”下拉按钮,从列表中选择合适的艺术字效果。
步骤2:幻灯片中随即插入一个相应的艺术字文本框,接着在文本框中直接输入内容即可。
美化文本
除了利用艺术字功能来美化文本外,还可以利用文本自带的美化功能,例如设置三维旋转文本、设置路径文本等,制作出不一样的文字效果。
一、设置三维旋转文本。在PPT中利用“三维旋转”功能可以制作透视字体效果,具体操作方法如下:
步骤1:选择幻灯片,切换至“插入”选项卡,击“文本”选项组的“文本框”下拉按钮,从表中选择“竖排文本框”选项。绘制一个竖排文本框,并在其中输入文本内容。
步骤2:选中文本。在“开始”选项卡中将“字体”设置为“方正隶书简体”,将“字号”设置为“96”,将“字体颜色”设置为“白色”。
步骤3:选中文本框,单击鼠标右键,从弹出的快捷菜单中选择“设置形状格式”命令。
步骤4:打开“设置形状格式”窗格,切换至“效果”选项卡。在“三维旋转”选项组中设置“X旋转”“Y旋转”和“Z旋转”。
步骤5:设置完成后关闭窗格。选中文本框,切换至“绘图工具-格式”选项卡,单击“艺术字样式”选项组的对话框启动器按钮。
步骤6:打开“设置形状格式”窗格,切换至“文本填充与轮廓”选项卡,在“文本填充”选项组中调整“透明度”。
步骤7:调整好后关闭窗格,然后复制该文本框,并修改文本框的文字内容,同时调整该文本的字号。
步骤8:选中复制的文本框,打开“设置形状格式”窗格。在“效果”选项卡中设置“三维旋转”的“X旋转”“Y旋转”和“Z旋转”。
步骤9:设置完成后关闭窗格,查看制作透视字体的效果。
提示:由于透视角度的不同,所以文字位置一旦变化.就需要重新调整参数。
二、设置路径文本
用户可以通过“文字效果”功能来制作拱形字体,具体操作方法如下:
步骤1:绘制横排文本框并输入文本。
步骤2:选择文本,在“开始”选项卡中将“字体”设置为“汉仪橄榄体简”,将“字号”设置为“44”,将“字体颜色”设置为“深绿色”。
步骤3:切换至“绘图工具-格式”选项卡,单击“文字效果”下拉按钮。
步骤4:从展开的列表中选择“转换”选项,并从其级联菜单中选择“拱形”效果。
步骤5:文字已变形。为了能够与图中地球轮廓相一致,则需对它进行调整。
步骤6:选中文字,将其移至合适的位置后,将光标放在文本框下方的中点上,此时光标变为双向箭头。
步骤7:按住鼠标左键不放,向下拖动鼠标至合适位置,调整文字的弯曲度。
步骤8:调整文字的方向,将光标移动至文字起始处的路径圆点(橙色的圆点)位置,按住鼠标左键不放,拖动该控制点至合适位置,可调整文字路径。
步骤9:对路径进行反复调整后,查看效果。
步骤10:改变“心”和“家”文字的“字号”和“颜色”。查看制作拱形文字的效果。
提示:将路径圆点向下拖动时,文字会随着路径适当放大;相反,将路径圆点向上拖动时,文字会随之缩小。
图片制作攻略
PPT中如果只有文字,则会显得枯燥乏味。而使用图文结合的模式更能吸引观众的注意力,所以图片在幻灯片中起着重要的作用。选择一张好的图片,会使PPT更加出彩。本章将对图片的选择、插入和编辑操作进行全面介绍。
图片选择方法
在制作幻灯片时,用户通常不清楚使用什么样的图片比较合适,其实图片的选择也有技巧。选择合适的图片不仅能在内容上契合主题,也会使页面更美观。下面就介绍在选择图片时需要注意的几点问题:
一、选择高清的图片
高清的图片能给人视觉上的享受,如果图片模糊不清,不仅看起来很粗糙,而且容易使观众产生视觉疲劳。
二、选择与内容相关的图片
在制作PPT时,要选择和幻灯片中内容相关的图片,或与主题相关的图片,这样便于观众的理解。
三、选择与PPT风格相关的图片
除了注意以上两点以外,用户还要注意选择的图片是否符合当前PPT的风格。PPT可分为以下4种风格。
1、严肃沉稳。此类风格的PPT,大多以写实图片为主,并且细节丰富,光影变化细腻,给人一种沉稳、可信感。
2、轻松幽默。此类风格的PPT,主要以搞怪的表情或动作图片为主,这样可以增加幻灯片的趣味性。
3、诗情画意。此类型的PPT没有明确的主题,主要以浪漫、清新或怀旧类图片为主,以渲染主题气氛。
4、另类独特。此类PPT一般都以创意性很强的图片或者以绘制的图案为主,也可以两者结合,给人独树一帜的感觉。
好图片的搜索方法
有人说使用“百度”搜索到的图片其质量参差不齐,不好挑选。其实不然,有这种想法的人是因为他们没有找对方法。下面就向用户推荐几种搜索图片的方法。
一、提炼搜索关键字。输入关键字即可。例如搜索“时间飞逝”类的图片,输入“时间”关键字。而如果输入“时间匆匆”关键字后,搜索的结果就大相径庭。
二、组合词搜索法。有时候单凭一个关键词搜索出来的图片范围太广,想要从中找到符合的图片很费劲,这时可以试着将几个关键词组合在一起进行搜索,限制搜索条件,这样搜索出来的图片会更精准一些。
三、联想词搜索法。有时使用关键词和组合词都搜索不出满意的图片,尤其是搜索一些偏理念或概念化的内容,很难找到对应的图片,这时可以尝试联想词搜索。将抽象的概念具体化,这需要用户发散思维来联想。例如,想要寻找关于“探索”的图片,则可以用“宇宙”关键字进行搜索。用户也可以搜索“望远”,对远方的未知,也能激发人们去探索。
提示:图片也有版权,如果将图片用于商业用途,则需要支付版权费,使用时需要谨慎。
在文中插入图片
一、插入本机图片
在制作幻灯片前,通常会先搜集相关图片,将满意的图片保存在电脑中,然后在制作时将这些图片插入到幻灯片中。
步骤1:打开演示文稿,切换至“插入”选项卡,单击“图像”选项组中的“图片”按钮。
步骤2:打开“插入图片”对话框,在“桌面”找到保存的图片,然后单击“插入”按钮。
步骤3:选中的图片随即被插入到幻灯片中。
步骤4:将光标移至图片右下角的控制点上,按住鼠标左键不放,拖动鼠标调整图片的大小。
步骤5:将光标置于图片上方,按住鼠标左键不放,拖动鼠标将其移至页面合适位置。
二、插入屏幕截图
用户可以使用屏幕截图功能,将在桌面上打开的网页或其他内容捕捉下来的图片插入到幻灯片中,下面介绍具体的操作方法。
步骤1:选择幻灯片,在“插入”选项卡中单击“图像”选项组中的“屏幕截图”下拉按钮,从列表中选择“屏幕剪辑”选项。
步骤2:屏幕随即变为模糊状态,按住鼠标左键不放,在打开的网页上拖动鼠标,截取所需的部分图像,此时被选取的区域会变得清晰。
步骤3:选取完成后松开鼠标,此时选取的部分图像就被插入到了幻灯片中,最后调整图片的大小和位置即可。
修饰图片
在图片插入到幻灯片后,用户还可以对其进行各种设置,例如更改图片的颜色、样式、外观,或裁剪图片等,使图片更加契合幻灯片页面。下面将分别对其进行详细介绍。
一、更改图片的颜色
如果用户对图片的颜色不满意,可以对其进行更改。
步骤1:选择图片,切换至“图片工具-格式”选项卡,单击“颜色”下拉按钮。
步骤2:在展开列表的“色调”区域,选择“色温:8800K”选项,可以看到选中的图片已经被修改为相应的颜色。
二、更改图片的亮度/对比度
用户可以根据需要调整图片的亮度与对比度。下面以将图片更改为“亮度:+40%对比度:-40%”为例,介绍具体的操作方法。
步骤1:选中图片,在“图片工具-格式”选项卡中单击“校正”下拉按钮。
步骤2:从展开的列表中选择“亮度:+40%对比度:-40%”选项,选中图片的亮度和对比度随即进行相应的调整。
三、设置图片的艺术效果
用户可以为图片添加艺术效果,使图片更具有艺术气息。下面以为图片添加“纹理化”艺术效果为例,介绍具体的操作方法。
步骤1:选中图片,在“图片工具-格式”选项卡中单击“艺术效果”下拉按钮。
步骤2:从展开的列表中选择“蜡笔平滑”选项,选中的图片随即应用了该艺术效果。
提示:用户可以在“艺术效果”下拉列表中选择“艺术效果选项”选项,打开“设置图片格式”窗格,在“艺术效果”选项组中可以设置“透明度”和“缩放”选项来调整运用的艺术效果。
四、设置图片样式
PPT内置了很多图片样式,用户可以根据需要设置相应的图片样式。下面以将图片的样式设置为“简单框架,白色”为例,介绍具体的操作方法。
步骤1:选择图片,在“图片工具-格式”选项卡中单击“快速样式”按钮。
步骤2:从展开的列表中选择“简单框架,白色”选项,选中的图片随即应用该样式。
五、对图片进行裁剪
当幻灯片中的图片尺寸过大时,为了不影响整体美观,用户可以对其进行裁剪。下面以将图片裁剪成“心形”为例,向用户介绍图片的裁剪操作。
步骤1:选中需要裁剪的图片,在“图片工具-格式”选项卡中单击“裁剪”下拉按钮。
步骤2:从展开的列表中选择“裁剪为形状”选项,并从其级联菜单中选择合适的形状,这里选择“心形”选项。选中的图片随即被裁剪成心形。
六、删除图片背景
PPT还具有一些简单的图片处理功能,例如“抠图”功能,即将图片的背景删除,下面介绍具体的操作方法。
步骤1:选中图片,切换至“图片工具-格式”选项卡,在“调整”选项组中单击“删除背景”按钮。
步骤2:功能区左侧新增一个“背景消除”选项卡,图片周围出现8个控制点,并且背景变为紫色。
步骤3:将光标移到下方中间的控制点上,按住鼠标左键向下拖动鼠标,调整保留的区域。
步骤4:若调整控制点后仍有一部分不在保留区域,则可以单击“标记要保留的区域”按钮。
步骤5:鼠标光标变为笔样式,然后单击鼠标标记要保留的区域。
步骤6:标记完成后,单击“保留更改”按钮。可以看到图片的背景已经被删除,只保留了主体部分。
提示:若用户需要删除多余的标记,则可以单击“删除标记”按钮,此时该按钮处于选中状态,然后在多余的标记上单击鼠标左键,即可将其删除,删除完成后再次单击“删除标记”按钮退出即可。
表格与图表
用户在制作分析类演示文稿时,可以使用表格来对数据进行分析和管理,在幻灯片中插入表格的方法有多种,如插入固定行和列的表格、插入指定表格、插入Excel表格等,本节将对其进行详细介绍。
在PPT中插入表格
一、插入固定行数、列数的表格
在“表格”列表中滑动鼠标,可以直接插入表格,但最多只能创建8行10列之内的表格。
步骤1:选择幻灯片,切换至“插入”选项卡,单击“表格”下拉按钮,在展开的列表中滑动鼠标,选取8行10列的表格。
步骤2:选取完成后单击鼠标,即可插入。
步骤3:调整表格的大小和位置,然后在其中输入数据即可。
二、插入指定的表格
如果第一种方法满足不了需求,还可以通过对话框插入表格,具体操作方法如下:
步骤1:选择幻灯片,切换至“插入”选项卡,单击“表格”下拉按钮,从列表中选择“插入表格”选项。
步骤2:打开“插入表格”对话框,输入“列数”和“行数”数值,单击“确定”按钮。幻灯片中随即插入一个5列10行的表格。
步骤3:调整表格的大小和位置,输入数据内容即可。
对表格进行编辑
在插入表格后,用户可以根据需要对表格进行编辑,例如设置文本对齐方式、调整行高和列宽、拆分或合并单元格等,下面将分别对其进行详细介绍。
一、设置文本对齐方式
步骤1:选中表格,切换至“表格工具-布局”选项卡,在“对齐方式”选项组中单击“居中”按钮。可以看到表格中的文本内容已经水平居中显示。
步骤2:在“对齐方式”选项组中单击“垂直居中”按钮。可以看到表格中的文本内容已经垂直居中显示。
提示:用户也可以在“开始”选项卡中单击“段落”选项组中的“居中”按钮,将文本设置为水平居中。单击“对齐文本”下拉按钮,从列表中选择“中部对齐”选项,可以将文本设置为垂直居中显示。
二、调整行高和列宽
在表格中输入数据后,因为数据类型的差异,所以需要调整某行或某列的高度和宽度,使表格看起来更美观、协调。下面将介绍表格行高和列宽的调整操作:
步骤1:调整列宽。将光标移至需要调整列宽的列右侧边线上,光标变为双箭头形状。
步骤2:按住鼠标左键不放,拖动鼠标,光标下方出现一条虚线。
步骤3:拖动鼠标将虚线移到合适位置后松开,可以调整列宽。按照同样的方法,调整其他列的宽度。
三、拆分或合并单元格
为了使表格中的数据能够合理分布,用户需要对单元格进行合并或拆分,下面介绍具体的操作方法:
步骤1:合并单元格。选中需要合并的单元格区域,切换至“表格工具-布局”选项卡,单击“合并单元格”按钮。选中的单元格区域随即被合并成一个单元格。按照同样的方法,合并其他单元格区域。
步骤3:拆分单元格。选中需要拆分的单元格,在“布局”选项卡中单击“拆分单元格”按钮。打开“拆分单元格”对话框,在“列数”和“行数”微调框中输入数值,单击“确定”按钮。
对表格进行美化
在幻灯片中创建的表格是自带表格样式的。如果想要更改表格样式,使其看起来更加美观,则可以使用内置样式美化表格,或自定义表格样式。
一、使用表格内置样式
步骤1:选中表格,切换至“表格工具-设计”选项卡,单击“表格样式”选项组中的“其他”按钮。
步骤2:从展开的列表中选择合适的表格样式,可以选择“中度样式3-强调6”选项,可以看到表格应用了所选的样式。
提示:如果用户想要清除应用的表格样式,则可以在“表格样式”下拉列表中选择“清除表格”选项即可。
二、自定义表格样式
如果内置的表格样式无法满足需求,则可以自定义表格样式。例如,设置表格的边框、底纹等,下面对其进行详细介绍。
步骤1:选中表格,在“表格工具-设计”选项卡中单击“绘制边框”选项组中的“笔划粗细”下拉按钮。
步骤2:从展开的列表中选择“3.0磅”选项。
步骤3:在“绘制边框”选项组中单击“笔颜色”下拉按钮,从列表中选择合适的颜色。
提示:在幻灯片中,用户还可以使用图表来展示数据,它使复杂的数据关系变得可视化、形象化,并且增强了幻灯片的感染力。
图表另类画法
如果用户觉得创建的图表千篇一律,不能引起观众的兴趣,则可以在基础图表上增加一点创意,这样图表就能变得妙趣横生,让人眼前一亮。
用户可以使用图片填充功能,制作出创意条形图,下面介绍具体的操作步骤:
步骤1:在“插入”选项卡中单击“图表”按钮,打开“插入图表”对话框,选择“条形图”选项,并在右侧选择“簇状条形图”类型,单击“确定”按钮。
步骤2:在打开的Excel电子表格中输入相关数据,单击“关闭”按钮。
步骤3:幻灯片中随即创建一个簇状条形图。选中条形图,在“设计”选项卡中单击“添加图表元素”下拉按钮,从列表中选择“坐标轴→主要横坐标轴”选项,隐藏横坐标轴。
步骤4:在“添加图表元素”下拉列表中选择“网格线→主轴主要垂直网格线”选项,隐藏图表的网格线。
步骤5:选中垂直坐标轴,单击鼠标右键,从弹出的快捷菜单中选择“设置坐标轴格式”命令。
步骤6:弹出“设置坐标轴格式”窗格,切换至“坐标轴选项”选项卡,在“刻度线”选项组中单击“主刻度线类型”右侧的下拉按钮,从列表中选择“无”选项。
步骤7:关闭窗格,查看设置的效果。
步骤8:选中“步行”系列数据点,单击鼠标右键,从弹出的快捷菜单中选择“设置数据点格式”命令。
步骤9:打开“设置数据点格式”窗格,切换至“填充与线条”选项卡,在“填充”组中选中“图片或纹理填充”单选按钮,然后单击下方的“文件”按钮。
步骤10:打开“插入图片”对话框,选择合适的图片,然后单击“插入”按钮。
步骤11:此时,可以看到图片被填充到被选中的柱形中,但该图片已严重变形。
步骤12:再次打开“设置数据点格式”窗格,在“填充”选项组中选中“层叠”单选按钮。
步骤13:此时,可以看到填充的图片恢复到原来的比例。
步骤14:按照同样方法,填充其他系列数据点,并删除图例,输入图表标题,添加数据标签等。
步骤15:选中图表,在“格式”选项卡中单击“形状样式”选项组中的“形状填充”下拉按钮,从列表中选择合适的填充颜色。
步骤16:查看设置好簇状条形图的最终效果。
添加音频视频
声音的插入与调整
在制作演示文稿的过程中,特别是在制作商务方面的宣传演示文稿时,可以为幻灯片添加一些合适的声音,添加的声音可以配合图文,使演示文稿变得有声有色,更具感染力。
一、常见的音频格式
PPT中常用WAV、MP3和MIDI等格式。
(1)WAV格式。WAV格式是Microsoft公司开发的一种声音文件格式,用于保存Windows平台的音频信息资源,被Windows平台及其应用程序所支持,支持多种音频位数、采样频率和声道,是目前计算机上广为流行的声音文件格式,几乎所有的音频编辑软件都识别WAV格式。
(2)MP3格式。MP3格式诞生于20世纪80年代的德国,所谓的MP3是指MPEG标准中的音频部分,也就是MPEG音频层。MPEG音频文件的压缩是一种有损压缩,牺牲了声音文件中的12kHz~16kHz之间高音频部分的质量来压缩文件的大小。相同时间的音乐文件,用MP3格式存储,一般只有WAV文件的1/10,而音质要次于CD格式或WAV格式声音文件。
(3)MIDI格式。MIDI即音乐设备数字接口(MusicalInstrumentDigitalInterface)的英文缩写,是20世纪80年代初为解决电声乐器之间的通信问题而提出的。MIDI传输的不是声音信号,而是音符、控制参数等指令、MIDI文件本身并不包含波形数据,所以MIDI文件非常小巧,非常适合作为网页的背景音乐。
二、添加各类声音
添加文件中的声音就是将计算机中已存在的声音插人到演示文稿中,也可以从其他的声音文件中添加用户需要的声音。具体方法如下:
(1)打开“XXX.pptx”,切换至“插入”面板,在“媒体”选项组中单击“音频”的下三角按钮,在弹出的列表框中选择“PC上的音频”选项。
(2)弹出“插入音频”对话框,选择素材文件夹下的“bgmusicl.mp3”声音文件,单击“插入”按钮。
(3)执行操作后,可以拖曳声音图标至合适位置,按〈F5〉键后幻灯片播放,单击播放按钮就可以听到插入的声音。
(4)选择音频文件,执行“音频格式”→“播放”命令,打开“播放”面板,设置“开始”为“单击时”,按〈F5〉键后幻灯片播放,音乐将自动播放。
设置声音属性
打开PowerPoint,选择需要插入的音频文件,切换至“音频格式”→“播放”面板,可设置音频的相关播放属性。
添加视频
PowerPoint2013中的视频包括视频和动画,可以在幻灯片中插入的视频格式有十几种,PowerPoint支持的视频格式会随着媒体播放器的不同而不同,用户可从剪辑管理器或从外部文件添加视频。
一、常见的视频格式
PPT中常插入的视频格式包括AVI、WMV、MPEG、MOV及SWF等。
(1)AVI格式。AVI格式即音频视频交错格式(AudioVideoInterleaved)的英文缩写,是Microsoft公司开发的一种视频文件格式。所谓音频视频交错,是指可以将视频和音频交织在一起进行同步播放。这种视频格式的优点是图像质量好,可以跨平台使用;缺点是体积过于庞大,而且压缩标准不统一,时常会出现视频编码原因而造成视频不能播放等问题。用户如果遇到了这些问题,可以通过下载相应的解码器来解决。
(2)MOV格式。MOV即QuickTime影片格式,它是Apple公司开发的一种音频、视频文件格式,用于存储常用数字媒体类型。
(3)MPEG格式。MPEG即运动图像专家组格式(MovingPictureExpertGroup)的英文缩写,日常生活中用户欣赏的VCD、DVD就是这种格式,今天常用的有MP4格式。
(4)WMV格式。WMV即视窗媒体视频(WindowsMediaVideo)的英文缩写,是Microsoft公司推出的一种采用独立编码方式并且可以直接在网上实时观看的视频文件压缩格式。
(5)SWF格式。SWF(ShockWaveFlash)是ADOBE公司的动画设计软件Flash的专用格式,是一种支持矢量和点阵图形的动画文件格式,被广泛应用于网页设计、动画制作等领域,SWF文件通常也被称为Flash文件。
二、添加文件中的视频
添加文件中的视频就是将计算机中已存在的视频插人到演示文稿中。具体方法如下:
(1)打开“视频的使用.pptx”文件,切换至“插入”面板,在“媒体”选项组中单击“视频”的下三角按钮,在弹出的列表框中选择“PC上的视频”选项。
(2)弹出“插入视频”对话框,选择素材文件夹下的“视频样例.wmv”声音文件,单击“插人”按钮。
(3)执行操作后,可以拖曳声音图标至合适位置,按〈FS〉键后幻灯片播放,单击播放按钮即可播放视频。
三、设置视频属性
在幻灯片中选中插入的视频,切换至“播放”面板,其中“视频选项”选项组中的各页与“音频”选项组中的各选项作用类似,用户可根据需要设置各选项。
打开PowerPoint2013,选择需要插入的视频文件,切换至“视频工具”→“格式”,可设置视频的相关格式属性。
动画设置方法
人类对运动与变化具有天生的敏感。不管这个运动有多么微不足道,变化多么微小,都会强烈地抓住人们的视线。PPT动画的根本在于因内容而变化。对内容的表现力越强,动画效果就越成功。
动画的分类
在PowerPoint中,所谓动画效果主要分为进入动画、强调动画、退出动画和动作路径动画四类,此外,还包括幻灯片切换动画,从而实现了用户对幻灯片中的文本、图形、表格等对象添加不同的动画效果。
一、进入动画。进入动画是对象从“无”到“有”。在触发动画之前,被设置为“进人”动画的对象是不出现的,在触发之后,那它或它们采用何种方式出现,就是“进入”动画要解决的问题。比如设置对象为“进入”动画中的“擦除”效果,可以实现对象从某--方向一点点地出现的效果。进入动画PPT中一般都是使用绿色图标标识。
二、强调动画。强调动画是对象从“有”到“有”,前面的“有”是对象的初始状态,后面的“有”是对象的变化状态。两个状态的变化,起到了对对象强调突出的目的。比如设置对象为“强调动画”中的“变大/变小”效果,可以实现对象从小到大(或设置从大到小)的变化过程,从而产生强调的效果。进入动画PPT中一般都是使用黄色图标标识。
三、退出动画。退出动画与进入动画正好相反,它可以使对象从“有”到“无”。触发后的动画效果与“进入”效果正好相反,对象在没有触发动画之前,是存在屏幕上,而当其被触发后,则从屏幕上以某种设定的效果消失。如设置对象为退出动画中的“切出”效果,则对象在触发后会逐渐地从屏幕上某处切出,从而消失在屏幕上。退出动画PPT中一般都是使用红色图标标识。
四、动作路径动画。就是对象沿着某条路径运动的动画,在PPT中也可以制作出同样的效果,就是将对象设置成“动作路径”效果。比如设置对象为“动作路径”中的“向右”效果,则对象在触发后会沿着设定的方向线移动。
动画的操控方法
选择设置动画的对象,在“动画窗格”中,选择一个动画,单击右边的下拉箭头,弹出的下拉菜单。单击“计时”选项中的“开始”按钮,会弹出下拉列表框。
一、单击开始。只有在多单击一次鼠标之后该动画才会出现。例如想要让两个对象逐一顺序显示,单击一次出现一个,再单击一次再出现一个,那么两个出现动作都应该选择“单击开始”动作选项。
二、从上一项开始。该动作会和上一个动作同时开始。例如把第一个对象设置为“单击开始”,第二个对象设置为“从上一项开始”,那么单击一次之后,两个对象的动画会同时进行。
三、从上一项之后开始。上一动画执行完之后该动作就会自动执行。对于两个对象,如果第二个对象选择了这个选项,那么只需单击一次,两个对象的动画就会先后逐一进行。
四、效果选项。单击会打开“效果”选项卡。在这里,可以对动作的属性进行调整。对于不同的动作,此选项卡的内容会有些差别。
最后是给各位职场人士的提示,千万不要为了追求PPT的美观而忽略了其内容的重要性,建议在掌握PPT设计技能前,将重点放在内容表达上,利用常规的PPT操作做出满足职场要求的作品才是正道。
%3Chowto_content%3E[{"type":"paragraph","attrs":{"is_abstract":true},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"为什么这个幻灯片背景不能修改?如何取消幻灯片的自动播放?","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"……这些问题经常被职场小白问起。这篇适合PPT小白快速入门的实用教程,目的是让读者学会、掌握、应用PPT,达到知其然并知其所以然。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnKOoCgWy2s0OMecOun5J3Pg"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":1},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"了解PPT","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcncCycMAUQGIuOq0CNT1ibEh"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"初识PPT","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnkiM6GQIqosIo61E2J3Xxef"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT是Office办公组件中的一个软件。使用PPT创作的文件叫演示文稿,可以在投影仪或电脑上进行播放,也可将演示文稿打印出来,供他人浏览阅读。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn2souogkOMiw0IQnH81UTVn"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"一般情况下,大众喜爱的PPT通常都有一些相同的特点:内容准确清晰,版式简洁大方,动画则恰到好处。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnqWwc6Wc26CAUW8SoYfLt5X"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、内容准确清晰。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"PPT主要负责传递信息,所以需要严密的逻辑框架作为支撑。因此,通过看PPT的内容逻辑是否准确、清晰,就可以判断PPT是好还是坏。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnU4McACmiE0GMQ9G4GkYzmh"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":918,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"初识PPT","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/ae234ea2f090450b96b44c75448c2bb3","width":1589},"text":"","id":"doxcnAYkIK4OiuIWma0WBsjVh3f"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、版式简洁大方。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"PPT是用来传达观点的,所以不需要制作得太过复杂。一些初学者喜欢将各种各样的元素都放入PPT中,结果作品的效果却不尽如人意,观众也很难在杂乱无章的版式中获取演讲者所要表达的观点。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn0w8Ao8KYS6sUKsQaXKb9Bb"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":866,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"初识PPT","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/25a172d309a34e7b8281c19557f8d49d","width":1536},"text":"","id":"doxcnig6yuuYMSMwkWcv9hdWnBe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"3、","id":""},{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"动画恰到好处。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"在PPT中恰到好处的动画会起到锦上添花的作用,多余复杂的动画则容易喧宾夺主。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnoeca8EKGgaMcUhs5UnOd8d"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1076,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"初识PPT","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/b5be636426c14c2ab054995ecf5ee087","width":1916},"text":"","id":"doxcnAgYo044cyaUwasHxuagvKd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn6yQsa02CYsEU2rlPEN3ULb"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"了解PPT的结构","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnAo6Gk6qUe0YuOTBsKfZ90D"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、PPT的操作界面","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnE4GaY0gqoQSSMqy6wNvgub"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT的操作界面主要包括标题栏、功能区、编辑区、文件菜单、视图区和状态栏。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcncqiee4mMM8gUot8OoU0DVe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、标题栏。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"标题栏位于页面的最顶部,从左至右依次是快速访问工具栏、演示文稿名称、登录按钮、功能区显示选项按钮、最小化按钮、最大化按钮和关闭按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn2AOkUg0SoG4E0QyG5Zi8hf"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1030,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"了解PPT的结构","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/e6e314eb00f649ca8dcb20e8ac28e02d","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnmciYGEOC82Ayyebpq5D2sz"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、功能区。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"功能区位于标题栏下方,默认包含8个选项卡,每个选项卡中包含多个选项组,相同类别的命令通常集中在同一个选项组中。同一个选项卡中包含的命令按钮也属于同一种类型。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcngIgwY08WamqcY5WsTRSHRe"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1033,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"了解PPT的结构","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/a415114be5c1487986fc1cc286f088ee","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcn400eMsuSEu2oc9IAytHSzg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"下面详细介绍一下各选项卡的功能。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnMSkoMC2QKgwOQNJZc9ocnh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(1)“开始”选项卡。该选项卡中包括“剪贴板”“幻灯片”“字体”“段落”“绘图”和“编辑”6个选项组。在此,用户可以新建幻灯片,设置幻灯片的文本、段落以及样式等。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnOwegsCEqMoUWg78WEKS8tg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(2)“插入”选项卡。该选项卡包括“幻灯片”“表格”“图像”“插图”“加载项”“链接”“批注”“文本”“符号”及“媒体”选项组。在此,用户可以在幻灯片中插入各种表格、图片、超链接、文本框、公式、音像等元素。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnUqGQeE2Ye24mCeFP6ZDANe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(3)“设计”选项卡。该选项卡包括:“主题”“变体”“自定义”选项组。在此,用户可以对幻灯片的大小、背景格式等进行设置。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnUE4ymcwGqauwwNIhfs8V8d"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(4)“切换”选项卡。该选项卡包括“预览”“切换到此幻灯片”“计时”选项组。在此,用户可以为幻灯片设置各种切换效果。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcniCieeQoyCMmeyaIuoLknsg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(5)“动画”选项卡。该选项卡包括“预览”“动画”“高级动画”和“计时”选项组。在此,用户可以为其文本、图片等添加各种动画效果。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnSy2EgOIGsCegGEvVGpQh7c"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(6)“幻灯片放映”选项卡。该选项卡包括“开始放映幻灯片”“设置”“监视器”选项组。在此,用户可以对幻灯片的放映参数进行设置。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnMsmU6YqG8QU2GcEvFh6qLb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(7)“审阅”选项卡。该选项卡包括“校对”“语言”“比较”“墨迹”选项组。在此,用户可以对文字进行批注、检索、字体的简繁转换等。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnogosEcQcI6oCeQOs1ShWch"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(8)“视图”选项卡。该选项卡包括“演示文稿视图”“母版视图”“显示”“显示比例”“窗口”和“宏”选项组。在此,用户可以设置幻灯片的视图模式、显示标尺和网格线等。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcneQ8gsGo4UecCK0v40ajkbe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"3、编辑区。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"编辑区位于整个页面的中心位置,是演示文稿的工作区域。用户可以在编辑区内输入文字、插入图片、绘制图形等。编辑区的显示比例可以根据需要自由放大或缩小。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn6qeeasK0CEs444bmvpPaNc"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1032,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"了解PPT的结构","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/1cbde2a4d1da4ebaa955540b38d20aaf","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnGuG2mY06eqWyC6mzMhAKVh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"4、“文件”菜单。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"单击界面左上角的“文件”菜单按钮,可以打开“文件”菜单,该菜单中包含“信息”“新建”“打开”“保存”“另存为”“打印”“共享”“导出”“关闭”“帐户”等12个选项。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcny0oY4eu6UcYU8zfCZS8EFh"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1031,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"了解PPT的结构","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/673b68f4aac44569bede0490cc0a7309","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcneOEm6SyWKgmqKaBTUuKjRd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"5、","id":""},{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"状态栏。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"状态栏位于界面最底部,从左到右依次显示的命令有“幻灯片页数”“当前显示页码”“拼写检索”按钮、“语言”“备注”按钮、“批注”按钮、“视图”按钮、“幻灯片放映”按钮、“视图缩放栏”等。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnMgIAgaaYYqImaryleEmWn3"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1039,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"了解PPT的结构","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/f9d18b99af964c5397e06c01ed0e6b8c","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnawwMqISOoiuuquQBX4SBTd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、完整的PPT构成","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn2gYkSkcEMe062maSA7oXfb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"一份完整的PPT包含5部分,分别为标题页、目录页、过渡页、内容页和结尾页,下面将分别对其进行详细介绍。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnwMUGmo6Qk6G0muv0eaW3Zc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、标题页。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"标题页决定观众的第一印象,如果标题页设计不好,则很难吸引观众的眼球。标题页可以是图片+文字的形式,也可以是纯文字形式。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnKCoIWi8EC6kw4OywH2UOZd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(1)图片+文字。以图片为主的标题页,具有较强的感染力,如果再加上富有震撼力的标题文字,那就更容易吸引观众的视线了。这种形式的标题页需要注意的一个问题是所选的图片一定要是高清图片。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnY06QMiW4e0mIsV7IiRRMFf"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":852,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"了解PPT的结构","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/d11f8d3e0c814441bdbf212822048e36","width":1523},"text":"","id":"doxcnOMQgeKq0KsQECIswu6ovBg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(2)纯文字。纯文字的标题页,需要考虑排版问题。建议初学者尽量不要尝试。有时为了避免页面版式空洞,可以适当添加一些形状来修饰。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnyyAiMu0UKeMmsBLmFS0Dgh"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":804,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"了解PPT的结构","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/45563f480ef04dc4b83ae78c9449f407","width":1624},"text":"","id":"doxcncYw2KiCQsiESOg7ISv9Mtc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、目录页。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"一般情况下,目录页紧随标题页之后。目录页可让观众了解PPT的大致内容。目录页的表现形式有多种,下面将分别对其进行介绍。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnqmG0oY6SMaSQcR3xY0kAAg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(1)利用形状。目录页简洁明了,能突出重点即可,所以使用形状是不错的选择。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnu28YggyeeesqqSQ7gpCcfe"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":880,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"了解PPT的结构","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/292e5d227792479db817fabf505595ff","width":1621},"text":"","id":"doxcnmUIk0Gk8yUaKikF4unoOPg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(2)利用PNG图标。使用图标,可以帮助观众更好地记忆内容,并且看起来简洁清爽,不会喧宾夺主。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnoAykwUkg40YgWUVg2VWwRg"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":919,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"了解PPT的结构","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/b96171d40b324deeb72d0d63a02bec9f","width":1582},"text":"","id":"doxcniiIWUSsO4CO0iU3aJzhWSc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(3)利用图片。将目录与图片结合起来,能有效打破页面的平淡无奇,给人眼前一亮的感觉。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnwWYKgAECCE0yMBcB3sQiBg"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":878,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"了解PPT的结构","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/093ab36feda94ad78209fe48b981cdad","width":1625},"text":"","id":"doxcnEs4YkOqKOW4qCUElpOlkXf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"3、过渡页。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"如果PPT的页数较多,可以在其中添加过渡页,这样可以给观众一个短暂的休息时间。当然如果PPT的页数较少,就没有必要添加了,可以根据实际情况而定。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnuIsaASIwQeyQcd0jHzEI2b"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":914,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"了解PPT的结构","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/ef1f47ba416f44779effba669b29c286","width":1583},"text":"","id":"doxcnCY20QUACSsQqkdnWhjvyZc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"4、内容页。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"内容页是整个PPT中必不可少的,也是最重要的一部分,多以图文结合的页面形式来传达内容。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnQaW46kUYuUMOA525y9fjxe"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":806,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"了解PPT的结构","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/aade9aa23f514f3bae935871d24872c6","width":1588},"text":"","id":"doxcnuaICgw2We26kCGRJd0Wddg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"5、结尾页。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"结束页可以写一些激励性或感谢性的文字,或是表达美好祝愿的话语。同时要注意与PPT的整体风格相呼应。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnuc22yaey4CgS46lBycsRVd"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":879,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"了解PPT的结构","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/fadff9472f76484ab3008c5db1f72852","width":1624},"text":"","id":"doxcnMUMOuUYY4akEWCyB7abH9c"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"三、PPT与幻灯片的关系","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcni2CGiIKiWIS2eusne4MDOc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT又叫演示文稿,格式后缀为.ppt、.pptx。演示文稿中的每一页就叫幻灯片,每张幻灯片都是演示文稿中既相互独立又相互联系的内容。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnAEwM2oQgoCoogTdRUPkYyg"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT的基本操作","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnKYAumSUOqqkAwvb2vnIgIg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"对PPT结构有所了解后,接下来就要了解一下PPT的基本操作了。PPT的基本操作包括创建演示文稿、保存演示文稿、打开和关闭演示文稿、查看演示文稿等,下面分别对其进行详细介绍。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnCGAQCMWC0Coe2TxNeiv7jh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、轻松创建文稿","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnmoG0sOauU0OS2fpp81A2Jh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"创建PPT的方法有多种,下面以创建模板PPT为例,向用户介绍具体的操作方法。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnIEg2KiImEOoooL7k2NbXAf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:双击PowerPoint应用程序快捷图标,启动软件,在打开界面右侧的搜索框中输入需要搜索模板的类型,然后单击“开始搜索”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnYmGqyg4aCWcIcrQzRAZUuf"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1031,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/bf8baa03fce84b80b4aaf19335be1818","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcn4UY88oUQaIwEWyAJSXo9ve"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:随即在新建界面中显示出所有搜索到的模板,单击选择需要的模板。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWcuSUQOAaMISchr5Wl6Hph"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1030,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/dfbbce5aeaff45b7bbc99a133ed49950","width":1919},"text":"","id":"doxcnaiwoIqwq8ySCo1704NUJih"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤3:弹出模板详情窗口,接着单击“创建”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnwMCYiKSCCYQ2sZDTcvafkf"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1034,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/b3b1e0039d474b42a670075cff24699e","width":1918},"text":"","id":"doxcnsqI0w2g40KCIiQtY8QvRRc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤4:系统开始下载该模板,下载完成后会自动打开该模板,即可创建一个模板PPT。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWicsMK6oU8CkYG1Edd6Ppb"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1029,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/e928708208fc4fb8a88b89eeb7ed2c01","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnIIgSo6cCos8E4sl0pT8X0d"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、","id":""},{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"保存与另存为","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn2GaAkiCIgkAAorFNWke1Eg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在创建演示文稿后,需要将其保存,以免因为意外断电或电脑死机,而造成文件内容丢失。在创建演示文稿后,如果用户是第一次执行保存操作,则可以按照以下方法进行保存。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnGuwqOsQOI8ocExIBQhUPLe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:在演示文稿界面,单击“文件”菜单按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnuuImIuA4mMOoAvYOFAybRd"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1035,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/3451d7cf327f42e2a6de7c7209035d45","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnieCYqmuAQiWmGmW44sqvGd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:在打开的“文件”菜单窗口中选择“另存为”选项,在右侧选择“浏览”选项。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcna24acOAcSiKgWioDnfNyah"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1033,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/e21daf5f9cbf4c45853597383f3a0a58","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnUO8seOoi6ugSyOGLnRdh8g"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤3:打开“另存为”对话框,从中选择保存的位置,修改“文件名”,单击“保存”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnYQKmSo68MQAGQZ5Jm2Dlug"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1031,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/f8cf4d9f77c54c78920a41f339b79aa3","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnsSKAGGKGIS6KuMkSkfxRqe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤4:返回演示文稿,此时可以看到,标题栏中即显示修改后的演示文稿的名称。当用户执行保存操作后,若对演示文稿进行了修改和编辑,直接单击“保存”按钮即可对其保存。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnyqEY26mukUuoYR7AZu1Vob"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"3、打开与关闭操作","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnwg6m2omQA40SI35xBaqbOf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"打开演示文稿的操作方法其实很简单,除了双击文件图标外,还可以按照以下几种方法进行操作。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnksSS2mawwwcCcZnykzMwNd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(1)右键打开法。打开文件所在的文件夹,单击选中需要打开的演示文稿,然后单击鼠标右键,从弹出的快捷菜单中选择“打开”命令,即可打开所选的演示文稿。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnsQIm6k8uEy2SYZzX1f1jSd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(2)打开计算机中的演示文稿。还可以利用已打开的演示文稿选择计算机中的其他演示文稿,具体操作如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnEQCkKkGQUSUSUf9M1RVVJc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:在打开的演示文稿中单击“文件”菜单按钮。(也可以通过","id":""},{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"Ctrl+O快捷键","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"打开计算机中的演示文稿,这种方法更加方便快捷。)","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnSOQWEoymoKIoKapFgTJ83c"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:进入“文件”菜单,选择“打开”选项,并在右侧选择“浏览”选项。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnSEwAQMm2oQ2kKOnJ5Neqwf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤3:弹出“打开”对话框,选中需要打开的演示文稿,然后单击“打开”按钮,即可打开选中的演示文稿。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcngK6s4KiICqw86lPFX4Vtod"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"4、查看演示文稿","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnCqWIiwSQWq6Qgt4USH2V4g"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在制作完演示文稿后,为了确保内容的准确性,可以对演示文稿中的内容进行查看。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn0gCCaUsYGkIKUHFN2443vf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(1)普通视图。在普通视图下,将光标移到编辑区上方,滑动鼠标滚轮可以对幻灯片的内容进行查看,或者将光标放在右侧的滑块上,拖动鼠标查看PPT中的内容。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnGucuIIIsOqEaio5UoAWh1d"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1033,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/84462995dc384bfaa99ec61fe58e89cd","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcn6umYe2e6Q6M6UOoHtgk7t1"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(2)幻灯片浏览。在状态栏中单击“幻灯片浏览”按钮,可在浏览模式中对演示文稿中所有幻灯片进行查看。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnqWEU8YSyQkqg2z6nEEw5db"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1028,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/6396a33250ac481c88f21256e51756e9","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnWgawy8CSek4KoNo5oeWUGf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(3)阅读视图。在状态栏中单击“阅读视图”按钮,即可进入放映预览状态,在这种状态下,用户可以对幻灯片中的内容和动画效果进行查看。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnOAkg0o26u2aSum1hIfTLdf"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1029,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/87af1049b75d4340bfb408fafad3924a","width":1916},"text":"","id":"doxcnekqeGAKgagSUmCVh4xCX7b"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"幻灯片的基本操作","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn2CM4qeKiyWIYodog1J4rKh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"前面介绍了演示文稿的基本操作,接下来学习一下幻灯片的基本操作,包括选择幻灯片、新建幻灯片、移动与复制幻灯片、隐藏与删除幻灯片、更改幻灯片的背景等。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn0cwYEWKuwQkSkrgp5cHR4e"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、选择幻灯片","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn6WOusuiIksm8UpopxhtcXg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、选择单个幻灯片。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"如果想选择单个幻灯片,则只需在预览区域单击所需幻灯片,即可将其选中。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnu0AWSAi8cCYOyOD3pjdWSb"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1028,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"幻灯片的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/a4982cdb8c4a4acfab760a69ba4e8e03","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcngMSMUkS0Mq4oCCvnVnJ48g"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、选择不连续的幻灯片。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"按住Ctrl键不放,在预览区域中依次用鼠标单击多个幻灯片,即可将不连续的幻灯片选中。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnie80Gqqiwgmsn47OMr7RzC"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1029,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"幻灯片的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/c4267f7ea0ff49ccb4576142e9680c67","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnCsCoc62g6KcoOKY5amcEgg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"3、选择连续的幻灯片。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"按住Shift键,在预览区域中单击任意两个不相邻的幻灯片,即可将它们之间的所有幻灯片选中。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnOokKsomiIisUQpjiEbmjGf"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1027,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"幻灯片的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/0ac6b0160e214c42adeb1318bc6624e6","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcn0UcIgMuoesIiohcCGRAZld"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"4、选择全部幻灯片。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"首先单击预览区域中任意幻灯片,然后按Ctrl+A组合键,即可将全部幻灯片选中。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcng4usUGIs4e8kGVz4cXAE44"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1029,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"幻灯片的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/31a45a5d7c6041339c3fc900c08f04a6","width":1917},"text":"","id":"doxcn24sGWaMCeeasE3AmFwG30b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、新建幻灯片","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnScyM0UiqAAQU0O3FxjQyzm"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"若演示文稿中的幻灯片太少,不能满足编辑需求,则用户可以在演示文稿中新建幻灯片。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnAeE0YuiQ6GSmOieOUEbJlf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:打开演示文稿,选中任意一张幻灯片,在“开始”选项卡中单击“新建幻灯片”下拉按钮,从列表中选择“空白”选项。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnkW60C6maaMQcMHDZwiHdCh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:被选中的幻灯片下方随即新建一个“空白”版式的幻灯片。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnkO2QCkEu2yqqsnmesdMnZd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤3:若在下拉列表中选择“两栏内容”选项。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnOgYOYecyYOKGM3819gv2Pf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤4:即可新建“两栏内容”版式的幻灯片。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnmAcyCkW4sokSWGsj6M6J2f"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"注:还可以通过右键菜单功能来新建幻灯片,即选择任意幻灯片,单击鼠标右键,从弹出的快捷菜单中选择“新建幻灯片”命令,即可新建—个幻灯片。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnoGUUumWwuKakmO7oVYBwBe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"三、移动与复制幻灯片","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnuuA2k6oegg48Sc8X3XgGQf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在编辑演示文稿的过程中,如果觉得幻灯片的顺序不合理,可以移动幻灯片来调整其顺序。若需要添加相同格式的幻灯片,则可以复制幻灯片,下面将介绍几种移动与复制幻灯片的方法。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnq4OIC2KQG4eqiKAIb7Pwrc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、移动幻灯片。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"可以按照以下几种方法移动幻灯片:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn0ECEKOwmS8isGS8ZNjvRvg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(1)功能区按钮移动","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnOGsyyc0iaIwEPTQR4JZgnj"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:选择需要移动的幻灯片,在“开始”选项卡中单击“剪切”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnGwa6UmCEuO2agBuOOtvGdd"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1032,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"幻灯片的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/dde34e8c6e7b465780c4270a7dcb2530","width":1915},"text":"","id":"doxcnsiA0ms6SIwKiCciHXidcuh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:将光标定位至需要移动到的位置,单击“粘贴”下拉按钮,从列表中选择“使用目标主题”选项。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn6asUkwiKm2G0FQod5FXmNy"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1035,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"幻灯片的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/e949dac2154c45ca8f70307718266da6","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnMeICsK4Akg6G2RQNywhvhc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤3:随即将所选幻灯片移动到目标位置。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn2mce0CgSagoqCmZrqePTnb"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1035,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"幻灯片的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/671cdb039813406fbd0a1bde70890f63","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnGO6gK4oeOkE0TfOBwTefmk"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(2)鼠标拖动移动","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnoAuEYSqqoyOewZAT3FZpud"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:选择需要的幻灯片,然后按住鼠标左键不放,拖动鼠标至合适位置。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnkyY8O0yAi6IgScCZ2qAGWg"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1034,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"幻灯片的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/c4e015e30d8f4885a2d14084757837f1","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcncUU6aESEUeomQRLdt0uU1f"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:释放鼠标左键,即可完成幻灯片的移动。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnQCmoW2wGYc2iMhpGtQJQrc"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1029,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"幻灯片的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/1bd31b33dd3743f2a4f2195b892cafdd","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnQe60yAeMeaQ2oHRbJZw5ih"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、复制幻灯片","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcns6AgEeY4YK86CJQwfn2Y6L"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"若用户想要添加相同格式的幻灯片,则可以利用复制功能来实现,下面介绍几种复制幻灯片的方法。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn0YCoW6EwY4WUMDFHfgLTCg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(1)功能区按钮复制","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnQkqqW82IUwGkYZVCUJNmAd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:选择需要复制的幻灯片,在“开始”选项卡中单击“复制”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWAEmOgqu2CqC0MAKClREqf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:在需要粘贴的位置插入光标,单击“粘贴”下拉按钮,从列表中选择“使用目标主题”选项即可。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnk4eSWMIe8IccumvoySFp6g"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤3:此时在该位置可显示所复制的幻灯片。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnwcIC2sQso0W2AZpd2M7PSd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(2)右键快捷菜单复制","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnqugKeYUMiKkqAFznZMGo6e"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"选择幻灯片后,单击鼠标右键,从弹出的快捷菜单中选择“复制幻灯片”命令即可。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnCGE8aQqGwKwuM1B2zSe9Fd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(3)鼠标+键盘复制","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn4gC2mu8IamOS8oWXy2vlRb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"选择需要复制的幻灯片,并按住鼠标左键不放,接着在键盘上按住Ctrl键,然后拖动鼠标至合适位置,释放鼠标左键后松开Ctrl键,即可复制选择的幻灯片。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnw2S8wSyyyKcSOkjYlOQjZb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"四、隐藏与显示幻灯片","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn28sAsOogQgCEY3bjjD1Ngh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"如果不想播放某张幻灯片,但又不想将其删除,则可以将该幻灯片隐藏起来。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcny0M8UESMSwmQwDmDL8Su3b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:选择需要隐藏的幻灯片,这里选择第2张幻灯片,切换至“幻灯片放映”选项卡,单击“隐藏幻灯片”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnYE6Y6eQuCmSAc0txEHdNfb"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1032,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"幻灯片的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/ca42f556a8814bb0aec8628874fe324f","width":1918},"text":"","id":"doxcnKyKOouiiueyiaGiKSIrSvg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:此时,可以看到所选幻灯片的左上角出现了隐藏符号。如果想要显示隐藏的幻灯片,则需要再次单击“隐藏幻灯片”按钮,即可将隐藏的幻灯片显示出来。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcns24SKIyYKa8QsxPMEEaD3c"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1034,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"幻灯片的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/a402c81d53dd43378b6997e016ac07ff","width":1915},"text":"","id":"doxcnskYEYomU6S08KgKbMhj8Df"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"注:还可以通过","id":""},{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"右键菜单","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"来隐藏幻灯片,即选择需要隐藏的幻灯片,单击鼠标右键,从弹出的快捷菜单中选择“隐藏幻灯片”命令,即可将选择的幻灯片隐藏起来。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnowGsuYAaCEsQcypHlmsJdb"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1031,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"幻灯片的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/7ddbdf155d964815933e6ed717b4efb1","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnEgKqQMAkcSSU8UMyeoZIgc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"五、删除幻灯片","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnk8Q8cIWO8MOOS0lmuGFkVg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"当演示文稿中的幻灯片较多,有些内容多余,想精减时,可以将冗余的幻灯片删除。下面介绍两种删除幻灯片的方法。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWkW8IU0ECmiQGFL6lRrPcb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、右键菜单法。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"选择需要删除的幻灯片,然后单击鼠标右键,从弹出的快捷菜单中选择“删除幻灯片”命令,即可将选择的幻灯片删除。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnkMYuoQsUqweESgsv91rcbb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、快捷键法。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"选择需要删除的幻灯片,然后直接在键盘上按Delete键,即可将所选幻灯片删除。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnUqkw42KwWcQga8i9ws0leh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"六、调整幻灯片大小","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWQsMMmoKsIy6oUrV0eJJxB"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"默认的幻灯片大小为宽屏(16:9),用户也可以根据需要自定义幻灯片的大小,下面介绍具体的操作方法。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnqkuC2EokUgUKx0BBTyHpKn"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:选择幻灯片,切换至“设计”选项卡,单击“幻灯片大小”下拉按钮,从中选择“自定义幻灯片大小”选项。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnUWmYa8SYoCG6cDMmWAdgee"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1034,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"幻灯片的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/a8553e2b803949bfac7a7b16819440ba","width":1910},"text":"","id":"doxcn2ySAkqAQeooWqEnpNtyMZg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:打开“幻灯片大小”对话框,在“幻灯片大小”下拉列表中选择“自定义”选项,设置“宽度”和“高度”值,单击“确定”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnIoeUUGo622uAoRQWdjeNTc"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1032,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"幻灯片的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/a4a2d03e36594676b5ae19e71e0e0ef0","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnqSk2MUmKmGqeW1Rd6cntht"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤3:弹出相应的对话框,从中选择“确保适合”选项。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnwUgaCiKkQK0iCgiH0R4AQd"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1029,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"幻灯片的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/d7ffa75f470b4d83ad3867833acd6b1c","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnAIgO4cYEk8ia68rZX60mAf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤4:此时,可以看到幻灯片的尺寸随即被调整为自定义的大小。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnaaWiQk6EoU0GesWgiHLbwf"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1032,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"幻灯片的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/e73708959b76474aa91690d4c1b0ae0d","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnqOUGIY2ASSI6SsXeFZKyAb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"注:也可以直接在","id":""},{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"“幻灯片大小”下拉列表","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"中选择“标准”选项,快速更改幻灯片的大小。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnaCm4GSSSSIGY4djRIXfbPg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"七、更改幻灯片的背景","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnOiucoaEs2US4W8yxCk3Yjg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"如果对当前幻灯片的背景不满意,可以对其进行更改。具体操作方法如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnKa8kEaeE62AKv3XrHwS7JO"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:选择幻灯片,在“设计”选项卡中单击“设置背景格式”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnO0acy2yOqIy2YTDGvJNd4j"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:弹出“设置背景格式”窗格,切换至“填充”选项卡,在“填充”组中选中“图片或纹理填充”单选按钮,接着单击下方的“文件”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnYKMQW0SM46WqyQrsLYUc8b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤3:打开“插入图片”对话框,选择图片后单击“插入”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnYW0iacAgOmSEKmzWmQsSFf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤4:关闭窗格,此时可以看到幻灯片的背景更改为图片背景的效果了。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnSgUAoS2yyAqwC6mS11XrJe"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":1},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"版式设计","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnkYMs8Q8AYmWyk9AJjLMkqf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"了解PPT的基本操作后,用户可以制作出简单的演示文稿,但如果想制作出精美大气的作品,则需要对版式进行一番设计。本节将对PPT的版式设计、模板的运用、PPT的配色等进行全面介绍。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnEYWm42y28KAI2RYX3bcjKh"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT版式设计原则","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnU4GKAA6QQcSiI32lVVA9X2"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、什么样的页面版式才好看","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnAAQEia2iuIcUqGElucio6g"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"好看的页面版式会遵循亲近、对比、对齐和重复这4项原则。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnUauOOgqG88sga8UGetd19c"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、亲近","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn8uKGMEyCkweO8y8xJXuKwb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"内容上有关联的要靠近,没有关联的要远离,同时要统一各段落的间隔。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn8Y60GkyiKEGc4kBQUeya4b"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":729,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT版式设计原则","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/83f798a2630a40c49d62da9137bbd06f","width":1298},"text":"","id":"doxcnKGOMQQY8Gc4qWsdaFshyec"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、对齐","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnSQMSOSS8q2u0KARm07dR2b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"各层之间要对齐,因为每一个元素都与页面上的某项内容存在某种视觉联系,如果随意安放,则会显得混乱。但页面中有很多个关键字时,打破对齐也能产生不一样的视觉效果。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn6k4cqQ0QYwiIAZhqgaBOWf"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":725,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT版式设计原则","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/9ccdf4c291ae4fa2afe3e5aa72ba347f","width":1299},"text":"","id":"doxcnGy0qaYySg6s8OC21CMJKlg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"3、对比","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnuMO0uk6eSY4yuC1KaSKfre"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"对比的方法有3种:文字对比、颜色对比和图形对比。通过对比可以迅速吸引观众的眼球。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcns4uCGaQAmqSYQlNf78nrwd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"下图则通过图形色块来区分各项内容。当观众看到这张幻灯片内容时,会立即被黄色色块的内容吸引住。这里需要提醒一点的是,对比的力度一定要大,否则就不要用。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnIqoGEiwAwYqYAFXnQnzGtd"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":849,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT版式设计原则","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/c8b7fa1718de4d549f926b60dfac2073","width":1519},"text":"","id":"doxcnUy20Wm4YKuIOacJOF52FSd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"4、重复","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnOKowoIE0AUqsOkX9wFXcZf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"通过让PPT的部分元素,例如图片、字体、配色等重复使用,可以使PPT的版式风格统一,避免杂乱无章。但需要注意的是,不要一味地单调重复,要明确每个页面的作用。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnGsocOCCaqAgYIvimCGcUTc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(1)标题页","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcngwCwCuiSuKq6aEZsaEwx5f"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":727,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT版式设计原则","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/a349f361ddcd4798bc02254556ff3d06","width":1269},"text":"","id":"doxcnmQukUYMkEWWGk7pmih7tsd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(2)目录页","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnqYcAaS0gw06QojDZGJExUd"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":726,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT版式设计原则","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/fd98e48abb8d4041ba026bf7e687a5ea","width":1263},"text":"","id":"doxcniEq6oe46meiWwxyGfudbqe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(3)内容页","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnuGiy4WAe8umEEnpkEtpRaf"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":723,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT版式设计原则","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/13e9831eb2c74f8281194105a9dd2687","width":1282},"text":"","id":"doxcn0Cou8C0sMEm6UXd7UTbuyg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(4)结尾页","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn6SquoiqO62qQgTPchcYRfh"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":719,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT版式设计原则","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/31ac79adc67b4a41bca79585fc8634ed","width":1268},"text":"","id":"doxcngymkqqUa0wSo2JEnK9wO5g"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、PPT中的留白艺术","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnwcM22SgacOKk6AanoRhX7f"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"留白留出的是空间。对于幻灯片而言,最直观的好处就是用户可以轻易地添加文字,保证文字信息不受干扰,和图片一起传递信息。另外,留白具有与生俱来的雅致、高端、文艺、轻盈、简约气质。下面就向读者介绍在PPT中人为留白的3种方法。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnKyi6mMuCI4uAJty8TIb4xf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、寻找简单的背景图。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"尽量用简单的图片作为幻灯片背景,然后添加与主题相关的关键字即可。当然寻找的图片也应当与主题相关才行。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnYOg62kw40iSsYvSraKl5hh"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":851,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT版式设计原则","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/dfa1577c011b4e1b9af0511c59a41517","width":1521},"text":"","id":"doxcnMq28yoSwwqeyKik0HR1S1b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、利用形状衬托关键字。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"利用精致的图片作为背景,使用矩形覆盖背景某区域,以作为文字的底衬,在矩形框中输入文字即可。该矩形框可填充颜色,也可提高它的透明度。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWiK4uYMcwo22IjUqt6Mn8d"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":770,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT版式设计原则","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/536ea5f50e154a3f896775348ce5b8c1","width":1368},"text":"","id":"doxcnEGKEWqoIGcwsAtHI6zUEAd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"3、减少页面信息量。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"留出空白其实就是做减法。减去多余的,留出关键的信息即可。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcniY4W0CqAIYc0yM1aY9Ngkg"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":861,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT版式设计原则","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/9239d42c32424080b916c1905fea7c71","width":1524},"text":"","id":"doxcn6Is8WsgaoAcAes8Ux1iKXd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"三、页面排版的4大利器","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnA6YyoGGS88WiYddezhIPee"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"想要实现以上4项排版原则,则需要利用以下4种辅助工具来操作。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnyOEMyiU86aWqqM9eXvkbQb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、对齐。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"PPT为用户提供了8种对齐方式。通过使用这些对齐方式,用户可以快速完成页面的布局,提高PPT排版效率,对齐的操作方法如下::","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnUieC8GQ4Yukq2xM8re041f"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:选择需对齐的元素,这里选择文本,切换至“绘图工具-格式”选项卡,单击“对齐”下拉按钮,从列表中选择“垂直居中”选项。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcncAA8ggsQsymke8f5hXaXae"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1032,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT版式设计原则","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/24cde981191f483cb1b67d9f3a30fb36","width":1917},"text":"","id":"doxcnGsweeiw64WSW6xRmwH34me"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:此时可以看到,选中的文本已经显示为垂直居中。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnEsc0yAoQWWg4gJ2hI9CSYg"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":767,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT版式设计原则","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/34296935d40d4d1ca9abb1fe87f13128","width":1375},"text":"","id":"doxcnw6K0oWWys86oOW2Uh6Spth"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤3:若在列表中选择“右对齐”选项,则选中的文本将向右对齐显示。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnCocUMImgq4y0WI3r8Lcgkg"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":771,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT版式设计原则","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/4307565bd11c4e9d97085a989f3e54e9","width":1377},"text":"","id":"doxcnuUaAcqqQM8uEkDGwR31Syh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、组合。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"将多个对象组合在一起后,可以实现整体的快速移动,当缩小或放大形状组合时,组合中的所有形状的大小会同时发生改变,具体操作方法如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnqeeoKeuuKmS2MXpgPJfeph"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:选中图形对象,单击鼠标右键,从弹出的快捷菜单中选择“组合”选项。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnomsWcMaIg2Ewiyd9nBSWgc"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1032,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT版式设计原则","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/78e6dc30ef924157813982161adfc813","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnY2mYMSMgII6YcfE3gdJtnc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:将形状组合在一起后,按住Shift键不放,可以等比例放大或缩小图形。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnsAww0sqssCag7mEpoXgglF"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"3、窗格。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"窗格可以通过单击“绘图工具-格式”选项卡中的“选择窗格”按钮打开,窗格的作用是调节各个元素的层次,对此也可以通过鼠标拖动来实现,还可以通过单击按钮实现。此外,通过窗格还可以隐藏元素,单击右侧的眼睛图标即可隐藏。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcniKg20EwYMm6mqfmoiYpQTx"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1034,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT版式设计原则","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/7cdbe3f54c594ba8b087e00311be3e0c","width":1908},"text":"","id":"doxcnC84I88GqiA6Ie417K3v4ze"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"4、网格与参考线。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"网格和参考线一般用来定位PPT中的各元素。两者都是在编辑状态下显示,播放幻灯片时则会自动隐藏。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnMgws2eq8ImIoIBX3fVDr3c"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"如果需要调出网格或参考线的话,只需要在“视图”选项卡中勾选“网格”或“参考线”选项即可。这两个选项卡可以同时勾选,也可以只勾选其中一项。在对页面进行排版时,只需勾选“参考线”这一项即可。在勾选参考线后,系统会在页面中心位置分别显示水平和垂直两条参考线。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnaGQEKOoS2g88KPftXyvY8E"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1030,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT版式设计原则","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/2f97feedd4944571b1bacafac8212976","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnysUGYUaqYuoceEUcFg0QXc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"需要添加参考线的话,只需将光标放置在参考线上,当光标变成双向箭头时,点击鼠标右键,在弹出的快捷菜单中根据需要选择“添加垂直参考线”或“添加水平参考线”选项即可。也可以为参考线更换颜色。同样在参考线上点击鼠标右键,在快捷菜单中选择“颜色”选项,并在打开的级联菜单中选择一种颜色即可。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWgkew6sEYQKQM1tAQhAQXd"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1033,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT版式设计原则","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/d7c7e6c6322443b390fba867d2b1a1f1","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnWwIQQYMwoA8Gw1HQvt0MQg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"如果想要删除参考线,只需在“视图”选项卡中,取消勾选“参考线”选项即可。也可以在参考线上单击鼠标右键,在快捷菜单中选择“删除”选项,即可删除多余参考线。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnMgyIoqeYce6qu8pizlTMLc"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"用好PPT模板","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnUkSG8MI80EUAEFe8wsPDPg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"如果用户觉得自己制作模板比较耗时,则可套用网上下载的模板,或者对现有模板进行修改,符合要求后再使用。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcny0CEEuEYowEuopNOktemZb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、如何挑选模板","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcncgWcAIam0wKgQvOS0pgO1f"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"网上有大量的模板,其中不乏精品,但选择模板时,一定要挑选合适的模板。这里将介绍挑选模板的3个原则。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn28yk0AeqOUUYOW0jvlgRIh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、符合公司形象。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"如果用户展示的演示文稿代表整个公司,那么选择的模板一定要符合公司的形象。一般会选择严肃、大方的模板。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnI2Mqc2MgoCUMq4Sm0Ew1nd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、契合展示主题。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"选择模板时要符合展示的主题,不同的主题对模板的要求不一样。例如,如果主题是关于儿童教育的,就尽量用卡通类的,或者各种手绘风格的模板。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnCEOQewmaowAOqE9xwNgCzg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"3、让人眼前一亮。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"用户制作PPT除了辅助演讲外,最重要的是吸引观众的注意力,所以制作的PPT要有特色,看起来让人赏心悦目,这样才能让人眼前一亮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnm4mwKIyIgMSCkVHMdbM9uf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"注:可以通过PPT论坛、共享网站、PPT商店、PPT模板下载网站以及达人的博客或微博下载需要的PPT模板。需要提醒一点的是,下载模板时需弄清楚该模板是否可以商用。很多模板都存在版权问题,用户私下交流没有关系,一旦涉及商用,就需缴纳一定的版权费了。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnmuIa42Gk64GGQRHvUS18zh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、对模板进行微调","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn2g6wY8gmyCwWcrsUe7t0Mc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"一般情况下,模板下载完以后,都需要对其调整,毕竟没有百分之百合适的模板。当用户需要对模板进行调整时,可以分3步操作:删除、改变和添加。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn8EmK8gEmOSE2QtckisBSdb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、删除多余页面或元素。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"删除模板中一些多余的页面,因为有些页面只是版面设计不同,而内容是相同的,像这些页面就需要删除。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnAaGwwo0gM6ocvmtRBCg6Ns"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、改变。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"可以改变幻灯片的大小、背景图、配色、字体和版式设计等。首先,可以修改以下幻灯片的版式设计。其次,可以将标题幻灯片中的文字进行修改,例如修改其文字内容、字体或字号等。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnq4K0ECyUgYgciGeHBNw2Rh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"3、添加。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"如果现有的版式不能完全满足需求,则可以另外添加一页版式。用户只需根据自己的需求简单调整即可。这样做出来的PPT既快又好。","id":""},{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"想高效制作PPT,使用模板是最佳的选择。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcncKsG4GoUo4cqmGZUql3Pee"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"三、认识幻灯片的母版","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnAyOeGquuCukOa0NYd2QVLc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"使用母版最大的好处在于,它可以快速统一幻灯片的风格,例如文字、图片、背景等。下面将详细介绍母版的结构和类型。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnmC4g2oGYUqiu89RtZeRCve"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:打开演示文稿,切换至“视图”选项卡,单击“幻灯片母版”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnSwieEIwKoAiWueHiH0nA1g"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1030,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"用好PPT模板","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/604df3b3357048cab968b45728ff523e","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnwiuqUCQYMcSiUHBpyn4V4f"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:进入母版视图后,在左侧可以看到一组默认的母版结构。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn4Aq4uOY0U4cIw0VPZoSxJC"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1030,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"用好PPT模板","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/940212a280e64e049a1b7951c3d36819","width":1915},"text":"","id":"doxcnSsiM8cacyMceERe1rWNHaf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤3:Office主题。该页位于母版视图的首位,也称之为母版页。在这一页中添加的内容会出现在以下所有版式页中。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnUIiE8CC0EekEeGnNRa2Xxb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"注:母版视图是由母版页和版式页这两个部分组成的。母版页仅为第1张幻灯片,除此之外,所有的幻灯片都称为版式页。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnySauWIQs8oUeAWEt7U7zkw"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1033,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"用好PPT模板","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/6054b0f5db8046789cd9bab77403e608","width":1917},"text":"","id":"doxcniYaSYY6AQGwMkNVrw5K9je"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤4:标题幻灯片。可用于幻灯片的封面、封底设计。与母版页不同时,需要勾选隐藏背景图形复选框。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnEAQCSkGAYAkOCwed5fD4Se"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1029,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"用好PPT模板","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/274cad5c7269496e976dfb4204161042","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnOmyuguUSa6UOEVXU2v2wmc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤5:标题和内容。由标题框架和内容框架部分组成。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcncKo6cueueGA24O75ftouuc"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1034,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"用好PPT模板","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/c17d02e2157a4eb8b7508b5c8645c133","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcngWUIyqCEq0m8Xl5eeBGeA8"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤6:此外,还有节标题、两栏内容、比较、仅标题、空白、内容与标题版式等。这些版式都可以根据设计需要重新调整。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnwc0OgMm2EWyOchcnkfEUrb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"四、修改幻灯片的母版","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn2qIIEUqQisQgKcsdnwa9vg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"用户可以在幻灯片母版中修改字体和版式,使幻灯片形成统一的风格。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"具体操作步骤介绍如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnoscgYY2QIC2MGgGQtQzobc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:打开演示文稿,切换至“视图”选项卡,单击“幻灯片母版”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnueAA6EWsQMGm0kslF477Dg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:进入母版视图模式,然后选择Office主题母版,并选中其中的标题占位符。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnIiCoYEASg2K62Rqs3AFzDd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤3:切换至“开始”选项卡,单击“字体”下拉按钮,从列表中选择“汉仪行楷简”选项。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnmYEwmCqoyuoyGCB1Mq4iXb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤4:单击“字号”下拉按钮,从列表中选择“40”。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcneyuI0eCYKsysZhXeiVpbLn"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤5:按照同样的方法,设置文本占位符中的字体、字号。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnuaYWs4quqe0IScEUW4gWLd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤6:切换至“幻灯片母版”选项卡,单击“背景样式”下拉按钮,从列表中选择“设置背景格式”选项。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnoaaMM80KYKguye2QfHmbie"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤7:打开“设置背景格式”窗格,切换至“填充”选项卡,在“填充”组中选中“图片或纹理填充”单选按钮,并单击“文件”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnKMsYgWg0W8uAuavhQ52Hof"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤8:打开“插入图片”对话框,从中选择背景图片后单击“插入”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn6uWqUqK4w4wKTXOx6A3TFc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤9:关闭窗格,切换至“插入”选项卡,单击“图片”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn8WQOSciykeA8MNoU0MkBLc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤10:打开“插入图片”对话框,选择图片后单击“插入”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnMG4Eo6Yki8GW65CIHdIlgc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤11:将图片插入到母版中,调整图片的大小,将其移至页面合适位置。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnKkUaSGOUsuYsiKwWHUdH7e"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤12:按照同样的方法,插入另外—张图片,然后将其移至合适位置。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcngAACmq4mKMUawJS425Rxzg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤13:选中标题幻灯片,在“背景”选项组中勾选“隐藏背景图形”复选框。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnayWIU62aYYqAoJG9FBwl4c"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤14:隐藏图形后,为其填充背景图片。在“插入”选项卡中单击“图片”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn6IQgwc0mMEauUPHKhhHSzf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤15:打开“插入图片”对话框,选择图片后单击“插入”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnUuM84u6oYkGsKkSK5sfTdh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤16:插入图片后调整图片的大小,并将其移至页面合适位置。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnas0iK4SiW8o86PWZl5M6Tc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤17:单击“幻灯片母版”选项卡中的“关闭母版视图”按钮,查看设置的效果。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnIkugGWSEGi0GSqzKsvpLog"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"用好的配色装扮PPT","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnEqYo82kuq8mU2TJwc9aJYc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT中的颜色很重要,一个页面色彩靓丽且配色舒适的PPT很容易就能抓往观众的眼球。当然也不能胡乱的运用色彩,下面将介绍关于配色方面的知识,为设计PPT的版式打好基础。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn8CqgCEoqiwCEuSvWiFd4xe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、几种安全配色模式","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnEyWoWy4giGIWIZ9i1FAMEh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、灰底单色搭配。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"使用灰色作为背景色,和其他单一颜色进行搭配。灰色可以营造出精致、含蓄的氛围。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnEU4QuA2kW6mkgDvP3Jk9Pc"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":770,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"用好的配色装扮PPT","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/57e5c80fd2bd498abf46bf8f34992cc4","width":1372},"text":"","id":"doxcnGEqUcOueawIIq6ZTTlZHTh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、白底单色搭配。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"白色是百搭色,使用白色作为背景色,可以和任意颜色进行搭配。白色给人一种清爽、干净的感觉。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnQ0qCcUuGuMcOecXyNDlLcc"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":723,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"用好的配色装扮PPT","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/db9141ca5bc94a128d56fef95d565f6b","width":1288},"text":"","id":"doxcnUmKy4eagAm8eczT80P3FIc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"3、同色系明暗搭配。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"尝试使用同一种色相、不同明度的颜色进行搭配。这种方法比较简单和安全。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWwmisUU680wMUZOHBnDc0d"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":776,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"用好的配色装扮PPT","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/390bfd836f0546f28ac11a14d369e0c6","width":1366},"text":"","id":"doxcnyEqIy4woas0qG6RcuARVGe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"4、只用单一背景色。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"有时使用单一的背景色加上几个关键字或图片,也能起到很好的效果。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnk4W4YYCeaW00UPx0ARv8Ed"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":777,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"用好的配色装扮PPT","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/40c2014f762a412aa29d5a454302a47c","width":1379},"text":"","id":"doxcnSQw4WU0iCysOyUBirnj1me"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、取色器的使用秘诀","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnsA62iawIe6IkEnXugdhx5e"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"使用取色器可以将其他PPT中的配色提取并运用到自己的PPT中,也可以从图片中快速提取出需要的颜色。下面将为大家介绍具体的操作方法:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn6u2CSEYWqkaYasxsTkGjLd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:选中需要填充颜色的图形,切换至“绘图工具-格式”选项卡,单击“形状填充”下拉按钮,从列表中选择“取色器”选项。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn64GUSAEwsSKO9KaYXeECG9"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1026,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"用好的配色装扮PPT","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/8eb0d616722e45d38d76b00f38eaed68","width":1919},"text":"","id":"doxcnkoW2Amw6eM4wc9iXrySUBf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:此时,鼠标光标变为吸管形状,将它移动到想要填充的色块上,在吸管右侧会显示该色块的色值。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcne2kS4WAgKoE4ALiY6lBqmf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤3:确认后单击鼠标左键,即可将选取的颜色快速填充到图形中。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcneUOkGemUgOwY2t4kg8QPZg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"注:","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"在电脑系统中,R、G、B分别代表着红色、绿色和蓝色,这3种颜色的值均用0-255的整数来表示。例如,纯红色的色值为(255,0,0),纯绿色的色值为(0.255,0),而纯蓝色的色值为(0.,0.255)。用户只要在“颜色”对话框的“颜色模式”选项组下设置这些色值参数即可,在默认情况下“颜色模式”为“RGB“。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnqIk88ggSqm6iYVQ7eFXfZb"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"学会运用PPT主题","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcncwwYSamaAKgqkF7NnmwYKh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"前面介绍了创建模板演示文稿,其实使用主题创建演示文稿也是一种不错的选择,这样可以免去用户自己设计主题的麻烦。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnccsuUw48CKoMeQTOll675b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、使用主题创建PPT","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnqMWa8eCMAa647duzuSEYkn"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"使用主题创建演示文稿的方法和创建模板演示文稿相似,具体的操作步骤如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnioSKm4A0yUWu2jFuppUJvf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:启动PowerPoint,在打开界面的右侧单击“主题”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnim66UuAKYkCaklhW9Fb5hd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:在搜索到的主题中选择合适的选项。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnk2I4sIK4OKKQucg2CKgQLe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤3:单击该选项,将弹出一个窗格,然后直接单击“创建”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnQy2icEKso6aaEjPAu5nN1f"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤4:系统开始下载该主题演示文稿,下载完成后会自动打开演示文稿。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnAgMscIOI026aIp3cxC0XOb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、修改主题样式","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcne2q6OkWYMOEOekoG9Ra1ae"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"如果对默认的主题样式不满意,可以对主题的颜色、字体、背景等进行修改,下面介绍具体的操作方法:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn2E2EKQgk2qCmIBvfNcFmBc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:修改主题颜色。切换至“设计”选项卡,单击“变体”选项组中的“其他”按钮,从列表中选择“颜色”选项,并从其级联菜单中选择合适的颜色。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnamgOKmwEUCqi80MFxTVgCQ"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:修改主题字体。单击“变体”选项组中的“其他”按钮,从列表中选择“字体”选项,并从其级联菜单中选择合适的字体。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnk2G40gOiUo84cbk1IcCgme"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤3:修改主题背景样式。单击“变体”选项组中的“其他”按钮,从列表中选择“背景样式”选项,并从其级联菜单中选择“设置背景格式”选项。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnCeMwMMysMcq0oRXEfUgxBc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤4:修改主题背景样式。单击“变体”选项组中的“其他”按钮,从列表中选择“背景样式”选项,并从其级联菜单中选择“设置背景格式”选项。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnosskEqusGAcQmKRhkriybe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤5:在“设置背景格式”窗格中单击“应用到全部”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnawIGmgiOiKe0odymBHMFFe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤6:单击“关闭”按钮,关闭窗格,查看修改主题背景样式的效果。(注:可以在“设计”选项卡中单击“主题”选项组中的“其他”按钮,从列表中可以直接更改当前演示文稿的主题。)","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnUyIS4W24kukKsCAkC5aZsb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"主题模板与模板的区别:主题模板可以统一更改颜色、背景,而模板则不可以。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnUI20U6eEwaaMSshCvby9nc"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":1},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"字体搭配","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnQ8aEEKwq0ke8nxqygk8dMQ"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"制作演示文稿的目的是为了展示内容,传达观点,所以文本是演示文稿中不可或缺的,并且在幻灯片中输入文本后还要对其进行各种设置。本节将对文字的选择、文本的输入、文本的编辑、文本段落的设置等操作进行全面介绍。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnKm66KoeUuCesOwns35jv9f"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"文字的选择有讲究","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn4WqIY88UOg2Ym2SbTF8kWb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"字体是演示文稿中必不可少的一个元素,要想制作出优秀的演示文稿,选择一种合适的字体很重要。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnCswUKSSKY8us6Te374ubFb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、选择合适的字体","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnQIkmC0qwsAq6iiAMJFh1Ce"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"一般用户会使用PPT中默认的字体,这样制作出来的PPT看起来千篇一律。其实选择一种合适的字体,会起到不—样的效果,用户可以根据不同场合使用不同的字体。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcneiGuIssQgwkqoz5HpbP2Vc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、普通字体。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"PPT中用到的绝大多数字体都可归为普通字体。例如,微软雅黑、黑体、华文行楷、汉仪系列等,目前大多数的PPT都经常使用这类字体。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn4UmAuUWy8Qoq6zmChEZjKc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、钢笔字体。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"在PPT中使用钢笔字体,例如方正硬笔行书简体、方正硬笔楷书简体等,可以使PPT充满文艺感。这类字体比较适合教育、书籍、文化等领域相关主题内容。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnSUoy8oe02UsqorpIkcLjnF"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"3、书法字体。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"书法字体很常见,例如日本青柳衡山毛笔字体、段宁毛笔行书、叶根友系列字体等,这类字体适合中国风、水墨风的PPT。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnAkYaOos8mwkGyKQDQ1Vlob"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"4、卡通字体。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"卡通字体在视觉上非常可爱,例如华康娃娃体、方正卡通简体、方正胖头鱼简体、汉仪乐窑体等,这类字体适合儿童教学课件或与儿童相关的主题。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn2EA0yCcaQMqUZ0hBYifBft"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"5、英文字体。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"前面几种类型均为中文字体,但在制作PPT时还会用到英文,那英文字体该怎么选呢?这里将推荐几款常用英文字体,供用户参考。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnOoKs66cQgOKqQD2aDaSYmp"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(1)TimesNewRoman。该字体是系统自带的英文字体,适合历史文化类PPT。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn6EigwEkeQqUAeT3dgxA7ab"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(2)Tahoma。该字体也是系统自带的字体,给人一种亲切感,在一定程度上可以调节现场氛围。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcncIEm0m0YK06IkxHYC5GoDg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(3)SegoeUILight。该字体比较纤细,使用该字体可以使整个PPT看起来清新自然。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnyA0U6iQMAa2gYNov38uHmb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(4)PalaceScriptMT。该字体是装饰性很强的手写体,一般用于文艺、请帖、节日等主题。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnO6UOEkkw448GayQVPM1oCc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"提示:在一张幻灯片中,如果中英文同时存在,那么英文字体就要根据中文字体来调整,也就是说两种字体要相互匹配。另外,字体也有版权如果用户将下载的字体用于商业用途,则需要支付版权费。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnASAycsc84CKGawVe0dj26d"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、安装字体的方法","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnoAAyksCMyEmc8TJqFONruf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"如果用户在网上下载了几款字体,想要进行安装,可以按照以下几种方法进行操作:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn8kA20cgIqku6AG5OcjWRZp"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、复制和粘贴字体。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"可以全选需要安装的字体,然后按Ctrl+C组合键进行复制操作,再按照相应的路径(C:iWindowsl)找到“Fonts”文件夹,打开该文件夹,按Ctrl+V组合键,将复制的字体进行粘贴即可。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcny4YGYC2Am6uuYJiQxFhopc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、“安装”字体。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"首先选择需要安装的字体,然后单击鼠标右键,从弹出的快捷菜单中选择“安装”命令即可安装。此外,还可以双击要安装的字体文件,在打开的字体对话框中单击“安装”按钮即可。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnGcsGu4CaaAqC6yTwopmQcg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"3、使用快捷方式安装字体。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"在需要安装大批量的字体时,为了防止占用系统磁盘空间,影响软件的运行速度,可以使用快捷方式来安装字体,具体操作方法如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnU0OSc0GGymOGYRFrK6kgUd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:根据路径(C:iWindowslFonts)打开“Fonts”文件夹,单击左侧的“字体设置”选项按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcniaGi4a0CyUcm21XACotUXf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:在打开的“字体设置”界面中,勾选“允许使用快捷方式安装字体(高级)”复选框,单击“确定”按钮,关闭该界面。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnOccs26souQEqw5jy2lX3rf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤3:打开要安装的字体文件夹,全选字体,单击鼠标右键,从弹出的快捷菜单中选择“作为快捷方式安装”选项即可。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn86UC20Kqog6Gc3lA4XErYg"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"根据内容输入文本","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcngaG0oKkcwqkY8N0OuaYbDf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"制作演示文稿时需要在其中输入文本,然后设置文本的字体、字号、字符间距、文本的特殊效果等操作。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcng2GUWQYUwsQMo5b2Yr7FRf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、输入文本。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"想要在幻灯片中输入文本,则需要占位符和文本框做载体。介绍两种常见的文本输入方法:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnkSwCic0WuCGoW4iV0aphpe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、在占位符中输入文本。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"幻灯片中的占位符由幻灯片的版式决定,用户可以直接在占位符中输入文本,具体的操作步骤如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnwOUYkqCSwkAeCyb0ZWheTc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:打开演示文稿,将光标定位至需要输入文本的占位符中。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnYsWu0m0A0Y2yyk1h1TVCNe"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1030,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"根据内容输入文本","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/f5b06831f2884d88baef81baecca9eeb","width":1909},"text":"","id":"doxcn8ewMsKEuUqgQw9ZK7cNYne"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:选择合适的输入法,直接在占位符中输入文本即可。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnq8qIoEYQcGYQmmPTwdYsqh"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1032,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"根据内容输入文本","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/c0dfcd663538428bbda2b22b866e5d8d","width":1916},"text":"","id":"doxcny8sGUaO2K0k6q6XCszZ6zh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、在文本框中输入文本。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"需要在幻灯片中添加文本框,然后才能输入文本,具体操作方法如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnUWuWGaoAi68AjUkZGQR1ko"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:切换至“插入”选项卡,在“文本”选项组中单击“文本框”下拉按钮,在展开的列表中选择“绘制横排文本框”选项。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn2SigUaOw60uS4cvq1KKY2b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:鼠标光标变为十字形状,按住鼠标左键不放,在页面合适位置拖动鼠标绘制文本框。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnwyM0kC0qaGsYsDkTSjtA6d"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤3:绘制好后松开鼠标,此时幻灯片中出现一个虚线框,即为文本框,并且光标自动定位至文本框中。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnSsGMMMq8I6umQ3ViXmbVFc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤4:在文本框中直接输入文字即可。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnoi2SiS6ukwiMI9DTmAp6Me"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、调整字体字号","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcni2EsqqswgkW6oNp0Wnj5kc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在幻灯片中输入文本后,可以对文本的字体、字号进行设置,具体的操作方法如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnsi6qYWksYy4MwhEWbpOv4e"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:调整字体。选择需要调整字体的文本框,然后在“开始”选项卡中单击“字体”下拉按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnQwi82ke8oQCKykbDvdnLTg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:从展开的下拉列表中选择“汉仪行楷简”选项。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnagWYeaciSsKiWgGwVLUOib"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤3:按照同样的方法设置其他文本的字体,查看设置的效果。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn08WMGWsgwcSQjsDomZ8Ocq"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤4:调整字号。选择需要调整字号的文本框,在“字号”文本框中输入“80”。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnq4MwomasKGOAg7moiDdi5d"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤5:按Enter键确认输入。按照同样的方法设置其他文本的字号。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn0UsSo0qWKC2gCwLCYLJdzb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"提示:","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"可以选择需要设置颜色的文本,在“开始”选项卡中单击“字体颜色”下拉按钮,从列表中选择合适的颜色,即可为所选文本设置颜色。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWGEqsyoWUyG2cN3QuYI0ig"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"三、应用文本特殊效果","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnqigeGKIWAwy0yo5SMWysvf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"如果用户想要文本特殊显示,可以为其设置加粗、倾斜、阴影、下划线等效果,下面将介绍具体的操作方法:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnOKKwkeou4ws2egIDun7sZd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:加粗。选择需要加粗的文本,在“开台”选项卡中单击“加粗”按钮即可使文本加粗显示。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnQyey8g02m64UgloNyK9ofh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:倾斜。选择文本,在“开始”选项卡中单击“倾斜”按钮,即可将文本变倾斜。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnUiUE86YY868yArCr7CJhNg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤3:阴影。选择文本,在“开始”选项卡中单击“文字阴影”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnYEAgOo0oCAU0wpWui8giSd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤4:下划线。选择文本,在“开始”选项卡中单击“下划线”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcngIAkIGEwYsY0GoJpIfzEhf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤5:如果用户想要清除设置的效果,则可以单击“清除所有格式”按钮,可以将所设置的格式效果清除。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnsMca8M24Ky2YqqOT7pturc"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"编辑输入的文本","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnGo2AYc60myAs8mT6q9fxyc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在幻灯片中输入文本后,通常还需要对其进行各种编辑,这时就会涉及到对文本的一些基础操作,例如选取文本、移动与复制文本、查找和替换等。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn0KICAeEUey88MPXXpXbLYc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、选取文本","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnYsq4cMKQOgoOMd5Wwmglgu"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、选择连续的文本。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"只需要将光标定位至需要选择文本的开始位置,然后按住鼠标左键不放,拖动鼠标至需要选择文本的结束位置,释放鼠标左键即可。此外,用户也可以将光标定位至需要选择文本的开始位置,然后按住Shift键不放,单击选择文本的结束处,即可将开始到结束处的这段文本内容全部选中。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn8QI8sGieMEsU8ICubyk7wH"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、选择单个词语。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"需要将光标定位至某个词语的任意位置,然后双击鼠标,即可将该词语选中。还可以将光标定位至词语的开始位置,然后按住鼠标左键不放,拖动鼠标至词语的结束位置,释放鼠标左键,即可将该词语选中。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnGsiAAKKq8G6UuUyslQ9l9D"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"3、选择段落。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"在选择段落的任意位置处连续单击3次鼠标左键,即可将该段落选中。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcngQ4KK4G0Waomod6BzZlg4c"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"4、选择多处不连续的区域。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"在文档中先使用拖动鼠标的方法选择一个文本,然后按住Ctrl键不放,依次选择其他文本,这样就可以将多个不连续的区域选中。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcni6wWekq6WoGcURQEXgcY6g"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"5、选择全部文本。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"使用快捷键全选文本,只需将光标定位至文本中任意位置,然后按Ctrl+A组合键,即可将文本全部选中。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWuo0kSIGauyMKSIWS58IKc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、移动和复制文本","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnwKggqOOSsucEumtpibzV0e"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"用户使用移动与复制命令,可以减少重复文本的录入,提高工作效率。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnCAE6uUC2CGy6WTeUiKvch2"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、移动文本。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"可以使用“剪切”命令移动文本,操作如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnGqKqcAeWk26iue7ZQKGK8f"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:选中需要移动的文本,在“开始”选项卡中单击“剪切”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnGkeMWMWgKqOcqgvtQsupTh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:选择需要粘贴文本的幻灯片,然后在“开始”选项卡中单击“粘贴”按钮,文本随即被移动到该幻灯片中。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn0AiWCOYYAKGaCIaTHsTY3e"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤3:选中文本,然后按住鼠标左键不放,拖动鼠标,即可将其移至幻灯片页面合适位置。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnwwEqOIEUuICo8g8ho1BpPb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"提示:","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"使用快捷键Ctrl+X剪切文本,然后使用Ctrl+V粘贴文本,也可以移动文本。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn68eu0sUuEI4iIz8jjteRPd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、复制文本。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"复制文本是将所选内容复制到剪贴板,然后粘贴到其他位置,具体操作方法如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn0qGA0OeO2gemGmMukpcFSg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:选择需要复制的文本,然后在“开始”选项卡中单击“复制”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnieyEqGMqUKm2GukquZYVRh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:选择需要粘贴的幻灯片,单击“粘贴”按钮,即可复制选择的文本。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcncCSescackqowMlL5l5zXMb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"提示:","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"用户也可以选择需要复制的文本,按Ctrl+D组合键进行复制。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnS2O0MkOSSIgkIjGf6VTGEd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"三、查找与替换文本","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnIkgecIuAqooOpjKrAyRdvl"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"当演示文稿中出现大量的错误文本时,为了节省时间,可以使用查找和替换功能进行更改,下面将介绍具体的操作方法:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnAyEsQuc8yag4KU2CUC0qMd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、查找文本。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"首先要将错误的文本查找出来,具体操作方法如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnmI4QUsWYao8gYVmig4ubdb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:打开演示文稿,在“开始”选项卡中单击“编辑”选项组的“查找”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnqWYM0I82aGuKmcaDblOEGh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:打开“查找”对话框,在“查找内容”文本框中输入要查找的文本,这里输入“想要查找的文本内容”,然后单击“查找下一个”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnEGcqos6KEKC0d0mWzzbnro"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤3:此时,查找到的文本处于选中状态,用户可以确认是否属于录入错误。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn6gYc0wOiQSqCAiH4SQCsus"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤4:继续单击“查找下一个”按钮,当查找到最后一个文本时,会弹出提示对话框,提示用户已经查找到最后一个匹配项目,单击“确定”按钮,关闭“查找”对话框即可。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnmCu6YUesCO8US2gLwF3DHh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、替换文本。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"用户可以逐一替换错误的文本,也可以全部替换,具体的操作方法如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnwk02So4sGwcayAxAzs3SWd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:在“开始”选项卡中单击“编辑”选项组的“替换”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWMkGMm0oCYkiUrmlcqULib"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:打开“替换”对话框,在“查找内容”文本框中输入要查找的文本,然后在“替换为”文本框中输入要替换的文本,单击“查找下一个”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnYg044k0oqqooeyXoATdP7D"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤3:系统随即查找到相匹配的文本,接着单击“替换”按钮,","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"即可将文本进行替换","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn4gW4OY0gO8Aqm6SX5O5KCg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤4:","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"如果单击“全部替换”按钮,可以一次性将查找到的文本全部替换。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnKUIYmQemoSyYaCyMCcXDVe"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"设置文本段落","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcno6QWOYkkwCYIiWcqG08pCd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在幻灯片中输入文本内容后需要对其设置段落格式,这样整个页面才能更加美观,段落格式的设置包括设置段落对齐方式、行及段落间距等。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnQ48KoIog0GsGSMfdW3ILcm"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、设置段落对齐方式","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnsKayCAS2GUY2qauQN8GJNh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"段落对齐方式是指段落对齐到文本框的方式,包括水平对齐和垂直对齐。下面将介绍如何设置段落的水平对齐方式。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn4OEO88GosaaQ8jLpTrfXrf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:选中需要设置对齐方式的文本,在“开始”选项卡中单击“居中”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnyCQAscSmeIaycHN415gegc"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1027,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"设置文本段落","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/ba0b15638bfb475f85520b25266f2f67","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnE6Cs4ukcMquIa7cCMYS2IX"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:此外,用户还可以在“开始”选项卡中单击“对齐文本”下拉按钮,从列表中选择所需的垂直对齐方式。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnU2cA4y6Q8UKoMFChchT5xf"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1033,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"设置文本段落","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/d4536daa5f4a4f1a8062c210ce8e1745","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnaG4igOyiYoqwvZTLVg3AKs"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、设置行间距及段落间距","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnuOGyGAaek0GEcvcaFbWsXG"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"如果一个文本框中包含多个行和段落,为其置合适的行和段落间距,可以使整个幻灯片页看起来更加舒适、美观,下面将介绍如何设置子及段落间距。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnGk6MGMQiE8okgDThUa9eDd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、设置行距。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"行距是指每一行文字之间的距离,设置行距的操作方法如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnosMqUc8ySycmkFt6E5iCzd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:选中要设置行距的文本,在“开始”选页卡中单击“行距”下拉按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnaKwWW4SkQCUUSKTW6CJIZd"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1027,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"设置文本段落","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/faa0d6809f7744dda6fb47669c525d49","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcn8kooSiU2wYI26mBgaRj5Vf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:对选中的文本各行之间的间距进行相应的调整。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnmgSYoe2kKCAomweOhgy6og"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、设置段落间距。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"段落间距是指段落与段落之间的距离,可以设置段前和段后的距离,具体操作方法如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWWqoAyiWOiCkag1NbuicTg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:选择需要设置段落间距的文本,在“开始”选项卡中单击“段落”选项组的对话框启动器按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn04K0S8SgwiewCCTm38h5Od"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1034,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"设置文本段落","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/3f46749bc6704c649be6cdc97fd4c9c6","width":1919},"text":"","id":"doxcnyQEuUa0i0GQsEnxRQoCcvd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:打开“段落”对话框,在“缩进和间距”选项卡中设置“段前”、“段后”间距,设置完成后单击“确定”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnSQgSaaykIqQ6aOaGPMLmnf"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1034,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"设置文本段落","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/ddbffb866d76442f8fdec353eb611d9c","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnKmucGO2kWga2CgEqPf6bOe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"三、添加项目符号及编号","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnIGC2Y4wMU8cyonnLppPobg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"为文本添加项目符号或编号可使文本内容更有条理性,下面讲解如何添加项目符号及编号。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnOSYCQoqi84EiGMZOQe4vnh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:添加项目符号。选中需要添加项目符号的文本,在“开始”选项卡中单击“项目符号”下拉按钮,从列表中选择合适的项目符号,这里选择“带填充效果的钻石形项目符号”选项。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnQ4SSgE0UiYEuWQrybrCFZf"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1029,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"设置文本段落","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/5cf7d98f35f64a2baebedd9b07181ce8","width":1915},"text":"","id":"doxcnScKCkiIWYaOIgJorkfOBHb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:可以看到选中的文本随即被添加了项目符号。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnQIeuS8e8S8QckDyM6ul8Re"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":829,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"设置文本段落","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/efd366487f874621aa28e279481de471","width":1475},"text":"","id":"doxcnQokkwoEQc8CAy0cTCZoVIg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"四、设置文本分栏","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn2wU40W402WsmAxvJAGtiXb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:选择需要分栏的文本,在“开始”选项卡中单击“添加或删除栏”下拉按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn4EIkeQ00oU6WMXp2DWNMlg"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1027,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"设置文本段落","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/1606f005db6f4811bac2b5b5ef1d6121","width":1906},"text":"","id":"doxcnkykSCUaoAuY4IVbbGRgOMf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:从展开的列表中选择“更多栏”选项。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnG2CqQqWaiuoamAwCDZzPBh"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1030,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"设置文本段落","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/3cb73103ca9f43f294b3e2121331c65a","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcny4QsG6i6MsUg8KoJtlKEGc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤3:打开“栏”对话框,在“数量”微调框中输入数值“3”,在“间距”微调框中输入数值“0.5”,设置完成后单击“确定”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnocgw6kEyQUwaOqwMbMDpbb"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1033,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"设置文本段落","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/481aac1988094555a242e2a2ad7a13ef","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcn2uIiqUcge8aCwvZ3HGiBhh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤4:文本随即被分成3栏,并按照设置调整了各栏之间的间距。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnSCSCeYSSA6ouq6lRIEOgPh"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1033,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"设置文本段落","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/4d09d959ee564f5b87959833342e66b8","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnEWwgaUksak2OsRLE533Qqh"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"艺术字的妙用","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcno8coEAKGUYoUElMCdOLy6f"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在制作幻灯片时使用艺术字可以快速抓住观众的眼球,而且外观多变的艺术字还能为幻灯片增加活泼生动的气息。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnOaWCEsgCyqC8aLqXhQMHkb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"步骤1:","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"打开演示文稿,切换至“插入”选项卡,单击“文本”选项组中的","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"“艺术字”下拉按钮","id":""},{"type":"text","text":",从列表中选择合适的艺术字效果。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWeiosogamqkgkl5XXgaA9g"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"步骤2:","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"幻灯片中随即插入一个相应的艺术字文本框,接着在文本框中直接输入内容即可。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnIwscMwiWUS0ey86RZ9OYPc"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"美化文本","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWKYGsGAaCAmK0eT6oJrfle"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"除了利用艺术字功能来美化文本外,还可以利用文本自带的美化功能,例如设置三维旋转文本、设置路径文本等,制作出不一样的文字效果。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnEKoqmG0OWwasQbmwuusysf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、设置三维旋转文本。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"在PPT中利用“三维旋转”功能可以","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"制作透视字体效果","id":""},{"type":"text","text":",具体操作方法如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn0gWwsQ60iuSwsXW1QE8tWd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:选择幻灯片,切换至“插入”选项卡,击“文本”选项组的“文本框”下拉按钮,从表中选择“竖排文本框”选项。绘制一个竖排文本框,并在其中输入文本内容。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnaCWesUkiquSeauVOZgCayc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:选中文本。在“开始”选项卡中将“字体”设置为“方正隶书简体”,将“字号”设置为“96”,将“字体颜色”设置为“白色”。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn2k2msyESekgqQt9W3lpU5e"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤3:选中文本框,单击鼠标右键,从弹出的快捷菜单中选择“设置形状格式”命令。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn4ASUwYa480268BWBbkUuae"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤4:打开“设置形状格式”窗格,切换至“效果”选项卡。在“三维旋转”选项组中设置“X旋转”“Y旋转”和“Z旋转”。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnIks0qkCoKQO0ugkcSobBKg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤5:设置完成后关闭窗格。选中文本框,切换至“绘图工具-格式”选项卡,单击“艺术字样式”选项组的对话框启动器按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnkMW88oMuiA8AK8h9p1CPid"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤6:打开“设置形状格式”窗格,切换至“文本填充与轮廓”选项卡,在“文本填充”选项组中调整“透明度”。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnYII40uG2s2siGCZkkKqRlb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤7:调整好后关闭窗格,然后复制该文本框,并修改文本框的文字内容,同时调整该文本的字号。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnEY6ie0IWgOymOOsBILIJXb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤8:选中复制的文本框,打开“设置形状格式”窗格。在“效果”选项卡中设置“三维旋转”的“X旋转”“Y旋转”和“Z旋转”。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnac224Ki02YEO0YBxNV0cZb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤9:设置完成后关闭窗格,查看制作透视字体的效果。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnMQyc2Yec2QuqGoDN5KlJwg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"提示:由于透视角度的不同,所以文字位置一旦变化.就需要重新调整参数。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnuY0OOsGoeUA82h24qlVjyg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、设置路径文本","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnYwA2MqGeQS0Y8ZWCMjJK7d"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"用户可以通过“文字效果”功能来制作拱形字体,具体操作方法如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcns6ksW2cGcIEcMZ6nifzuJe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:绘制横排文本框并输入文本。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnGAGc4AOi6emKATYLr3yvve"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:选择文本,在“开始”选项卡中将“字体”设置为“汉仪橄榄体简”,将“字号”设置为“44”,将“字体颜色”设置为“深绿色”。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn0IcCw84ykQOeYj4mCt6Lug"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤3:切换至“绘图工具-格式”选项卡,单击“文字效果”下拉按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnaww4OMcOck6yCyKUu6ezMb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤4:从展开的列表中选择“转换”选项,并从其级联菜单中选择“拱形”效果。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnkuWmeew8wI0msrQh0ngSog"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤5:文字已变形。为了能够与图中地球轮廓相一致,则需对它进行调整。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnSq2yikwMAuo68Rguq31Xzf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤6:选中文字,将其移至合适的位置后,将光标放在文本框下方的中点上,此时光标变为双向箭头。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn02oSoY4kOcQoWegH1Tnr4B"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤7:按住鼠标左键不放,向下拖动鼠标至合适位置,调整文字的弯曲度。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnskOi6EuwuWqsudVi4TmhXl"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤8:调整文字的方向,将光标移动至文字起始处的路径圆点(橙色的圆点)位置,按住鼠标左键不放,拖动该控制点至合适位置,可调整文字路径。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnK4Cg46OKM4eaeIGQtxVvPd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤9:对路径进行反复调整后,查看效果。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnK0EWKwiY2sqWqKi89YO63b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤10:改变“心”和“家”文字的“字号”和“颜色”。查看制作拱形文字的效果。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnKS8KWwY8IYI6mISj9W79bf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"提示:将路径圆点向下拖动时,文字会随着路径适当放大;相反,将路径圆点向上拖动时,文字会随之缩小。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn8KAackM62y6sGQZ3zCzVZf"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":1},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"图片制作攻略","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnA6AE6kkYqCGsqYFJM6eRBg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT中如果只有文字,则会显得枯燥乏味。而使用图文结合的模式更能吸引观众的注意力,所以图片在幻灯片中起着重要的作用。选择一张好的图片,会使PPT更加出彩。本章将对图片的选择、插入和编辑操作进行全面介绍。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnMeeIYuOgWqewiGeuThhVGd"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"图片选择方法","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnMSIMIScyq44ekBb7oPrr4f"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在制作幻灯片时,用户通常不清楚使用什么样的图片比较合适,其实图片的选择也有技巧。选择合适的图片不仅能在内容上契合主题,也会使页面更美观。下面就介绍在选择图片时需要注意的几点问题:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnicIiE4MeIew06pVGoxFmme"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、选择高清的图片","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWI66K0wmSkWEW2JMrAOp8g"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"高清的图片能给人视觉上的享受,如果图片模糊不清,不仅看起来很粗糙,而且容易使观众产生视觉疲劳。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWOMk4cOQAoG2YrGyNYjEGh"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":601,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"图片选择方法","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/65e757ac69854441bd0d1eed79e1413c","width":975},"text":"","id":"doxcnA2wKweqA0EUQ0UzFlCXWtc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、选择与内容相关的图片","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnaOwGwK6wk0ci0QieI0qfFg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在制作PPT时,要选择和幻灯片中内容相关的图片,或与主题相关的图片,这样便于观众的理解。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWQ4AeKwwEiqAeWd04tAOpg"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":608,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"图片选择方法","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/f6e65506900b452a938d4a2e72036a2d","width":1028},"text":"","id":"doxcnQgIUCymo82mGeiF4MOeIjf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"三、选择与PPT风格相关的图片","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnI4MiiaagwiWQURQmH6YJOh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"除了注意以上两点以外,用户还要注意选择的图片是否符合当前PPT的风格。PPT可分为以下4种风格。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnE2gIgKmAKigmIdZJtc1YLh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、严肃沉稳。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"此类风格的PPT,大多以写实图片为主,并且细节丰富,光影变化细腻,给人一种沉稳、可信感。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcneEyC4iKoIiqgyAXTCBTEwg"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":604,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"图片选择方法","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/4f98cadfb19746d694f885276d628f78","width":806},"text":"","id":"doxcnWU6WMMiASq8IQP0loMYyGc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、轻松幽默。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"此类风格的PPT,主要以搞怪的表情或动作图片为主,这样可以增加幻灯片的趣味性。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnqkkWGUswU4cycNiDbkOEb6"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":611,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"图片选择方法","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/3cc89cca796845d0bb8a87a6c66546a3","width":1056},"text":"","id":"doxcnKkK6Io6cOCaITyzudml6ph"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"3、诗情画意。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"此类型的PPT没有明确的主题,主要以浪漫、清新或怀旧类图片为主,以渲染主题气氛。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnakEWQwKyqKOs4k18fIa9Kd"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":680,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"图片选择方法","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/bafd85d627464ab18d9e66f993c76e73","width":1119},"text":"","id":"doxcnoiMe0W8UGqSWKUotBeeG8d"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"4、另类独特。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"此类PPT一般都以创意性很强的图片或者以绘制的图案为主,也可以两者结合,给人","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"独树一帜","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"的感觉。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn4q2GAUm8e40McxXV1cI2Lh"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":714,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"图片选择方法","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/0dc62dd4c3734e0a98e3719536dd5461","width":962},"text":"","id":"doxcnUAIgySY8eyuQEFptj5wALb"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"好图片的搜索方法","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnAuc0iekWCkWO2B0NGmxqde"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"有人说使用“百度”搜索到的图片其质量参差不齐,不好挑选。其实不然,有这种想法的人是因为他们没有找对方法。下面就向用户推荐几种搜索图片的方法。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcngSMeAymS8iiUQlndQr2Ouf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、提炼搜索关键字。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"输入关键字即可。例如搜索“时间飞逝”类的图片,输入“时间”关键字。而如果输入“时间匆匆”关键字后,搜索的结果就大相径庭。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnwU4M88MWcG2Mm4zMC1osZg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、组合词搜索法。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"有时候单凭一个关键词搜索出来的图片范围太广,想要从中找到符合的图片很费劲,这时可以试着将几个关键词组合在一起进行搜索,限制搜索条件,这样搜索出来的图片会更精准一些。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWaaouyYoIwYs4Lud0IScmf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"三、联想词搜索法。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"有时使用关键词和组合词都搜索不出满意的图片,尤其是搜索一些偏理念或概念化的内容,很难找到对应的图片,这时可以尝试联想词搜索。将抽象的概念具体化,这需要用户发散思维来联想。例如,想要寻找关于“探索”的图片,则可以用“宇宙”关键字进行搜索。用户也可以搜索“望远”,对远方的未知,也能激发人们去探索。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnoASKi4iooAgEMfDWcUzA7b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"提示:图片也有版权,如果将图片用于商业用途,则需要支付版权费,使用时需要谨慎。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnmKo0GiKSMOKaGOUfsEjeoc"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"在文中插入图片","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcngCiEI6e0eekUyIJx9ADxsc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、插入本机图片","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn0qKiAqcmioaMAJtKFK7rOd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在制作幻灯片前,通常会先搜集相关图片,将满意的图片保存在电脑中,然后在制作时将这些图片插入到幻灯片中。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcniCUG4QSikYUk2rrde5mUTh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:打开演示文稿,切换至“插入”选项卡,单击“图像”选项组中的“图片”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcngOQsEW0uWieyuM7jIr8dsC"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1031,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"在文中插入图片","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/83f0a684a16d4884a9997e6f9930b34a","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnaWY8GAEouUiw2fGagdER3b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:打开“插入图片”对话框,在“桌面”找到保存的图片,然后单击“插入”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnSU4IAsW4A6KGSC3YHoo87f"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1027,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"在文中插入图片","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/6beaa2f9175e485393c34a186fb0d18c","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcn0akQY02u6GIkuwUFA1cuEd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤3:选中的图片随即被插入到幻灯片中。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnoyS8s82kYi8ec6hjAwKFWb"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":942,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"在文中插入图片","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/0883b834cb7147568af79000ea7b6fde","width":1852},"text":"","id":"doxcnGqEMw8gse2wI6ptRKfbl2e"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤4:将光标移至图片右下角的控制点上,按住鼠标左键不放,拖动鼠标调整图片的大小。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnUyeaGUwU0K2YcEJJY3mtlB"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1033,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"在文中插入图片","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/80c5a148c9a54106a21e159d6f967d92","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnEywkI8M22SiKi0UZPKkYee"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤5:将光标置于图片上方,按住鼠标左键不放,拖动鼠标将其移至页面合适位置。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnkgIamiSSOyeMwBe0KXhP8g"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1027,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"在文中插入图片","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/d5ab9c486a5f450aa839f89932bdb4e4","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnmk4KW2kuaoOiYNoV8DI4Hb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、插入屏幕截图","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnKIq4cWgcU0G68TfFqqsQqb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"用户可以使用屏幕截图功能,将在桌面上打开的网页或其他内容捕捉下来的图片插入到幻灯片中,下面介绍具体的操作方法。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnqaAUkUM8Mc4mu0pYXjYsrd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:选择幻灯片,在“插入”选项卡中单击“图像”选项组中的“屏幕截图”下拉按钮,从列表中选择“屏幕剪辑”选项。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnsMMSY2QmKMWyuiqnbNwpE4"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1031,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"在文中插入图片","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/2a30c15705594a81b8d1152d13ab86b7","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnI8K8K6IEo2eCwXRmJpLc6d"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:屏幕随即变为模糊状态,按住鼠标左键不放,在打开的网页上拖动鼠标,截取所需的部分图像,此时被选取的区域会变得清晰。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnqaeYmUEeYYA68AjoK8TXmc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤3:选取完成后松开鼠标,此时选取的部分图像就被插入到了幻灯片中,最后调整图片的大小和位置即可。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnW2uWoc2Auk6UewI7Lr1Z2d"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"修饰图片","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnKWc2Qk6wgyGuSfIUpbSSAG"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在图片插入到幻灯片后,用户还可以对其进行各种设置,例如更改图片的颜色、样式、外观,或裁剪图片等,使图片更加契合幻灯片页面。下面将分别对其进行详细介绍。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcncUm4g8wo4wgKO8UdiwppYf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、更改图片的颜色","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn2eCEsgCkGQcEohcP3Gquhd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"如果用户对图片的颜色不满意,可以对其进行更改。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn4mUMsCYq8eq4E9r54e1Wch"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:选择图片,切换至“图片工具-格式”选项卡,单击“颜色”下拉按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnQG2kUWwSia2ash9xcVOOk1"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1030,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"修饰图片","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/5b079a7044d04857b7d3f8f679a7e265","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcneAKMUOcmKwSkEyMOASbZhb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:在展开列表的“色调”区域,选择“色温:8800K”选项,可以看到选中的图片已经被修改为相应的颜色。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcneAG4yCOcSKc08L54Q7iwQd"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1034,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"修饰图片","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/769824bd50d742f8ba0d793594d5c82d","width":1919},"text":"","id":"doxcnYUWOCiwGmu6SSy3OIFyqye"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、更改图片的亮度/对比度","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnW48qE2yU84CmCIGQETeKzb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"用户可以根据需要调整图片的亮度与对比度。下面以将图片更改为“亮度:+40%对比度:-40%”为例,介绍具体的操作方法。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnAuyQkcGaAKg6E9DNujKPle"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:选中图片,在“图片工具-格式”选项卡中单击“校正”下拉按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcniA62cQcIkuaS0y3OZOwXTg"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1030,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"修饰图片","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/c5648557f4de45069aebf16eb73384ef","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnEMIgo4SeOcE4CY0XedriMe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:从展开的列表中选择“亮度:+40%对比度:-40%”选项,选中图片的亮度和对比度随即进行相应的调整。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnkGIuAweiocemiCm6nOTVWf"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1037,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"修饰图片","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/10ac0d7bce7f4514834c00537dc5ca99","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnQGC6s46mqQwYGEjq7qwkqe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"三、设置图片的艺术效果","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnC6UYoISaqoUA0KJPApXFKd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"用户可以为图片添加艺术效果,使图片更具有艺术气息。下面以为图片添加“纹理化”艺术效果为例,介绍具体的操作方法。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnEiu4Yk48eQqmGS6QQCngxg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:选中图片,在“图片工具-格式”选项卡中单击“艺术效果”下拉按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnwOaeAec80aEKE36hlSKWKd"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1030,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"修饰图片","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/4afda3a9db564c9fa1c17cf96e78e3dc","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnSqmA4uC28cWOesLQ9hKXFb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:从展开的列表中选择“蜡笔平滑”选项,选中的图片随即应用了该艺术效果。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnA8Iq0soSWYYqKYwYUzBCQc"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1031,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"修饰图片","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/8865fcbc8e4b475f8ee4b204f7d1cf6e","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnmWWMaiIEMyueOYRu3Unsif"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"提示:","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"用户可以在“艺术效果”下拉列表中选择“艺术效果选项”选项,打开“设置图片格式”窗格,在“艺术效果”选项组中可以设置“透明度”和“缩放”选项来调整运用的艺术效果。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnIkMoEsWSc6oO6cAcewfKTf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"四、设置图片样式","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn6Y4sIWeQMY666RCLRNOI2b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT内置了很多图片样式,用户可以根据需要设置相应的图片样式。下面以将图片的样式设置为“简单框架,白色”为例,介绍具体的操作方法。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcny8gMWKk0iuCcyyqJPe2XNg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:选择图片,在“图片工具-格式”选项卡中单击“快速样式”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnw8kCC4G8KccauO3am5Xvnb"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1028,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"修饰图片","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/bdc302d9605e4ff380665b677fbd7a56","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnaiOowmu4wQkqUJoStrUmLg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:从展开的列表中选择“简单框架,白色”选项,选中的图片随即应用该样式。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnE4iwok2cSa0Yk3bVfshgVb"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1029,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"修饰图片","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/762db9e95c0d4f0d9141e29334de00fb","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcn4gS2Ko8gmoWgKC6QoIh23b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"五、对图片进行裁剪","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnimgUm8MWYe04F5Un4mbvFA"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"当幻灯片中的图片尺寸过大时,为了不影响整体美观,用户可以对其进行裁剪。下面以将图片裁剪成“心形”为例,向用户介绍图片的裁剪操作。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnkSOKsC6MEaaGqOcFUPAMVd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:选中需要裁剪的图片,在“图片工具-格式”选项卡中单击“裁剪”下拉按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn0OK8q24g0cEmCM0ktKnA4g"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1031,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"修饰图片","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/cf3cac3c802547e39145322e11104d50","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnqE0ooSSWYckKEhELLze0ig"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:从展开的列表中选择“裁剪为形状”选项,并从其级联菜单中选择合适的形状,这里选择“心形”选项。选中的图片随即被裁剪成心形。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn6IW64k2MOWSYaye6LbErzf"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1036,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"修饰图片","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/95dc36ff7bbc45ddafe18f559b516033","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnSscKMaqmuws0E09ibtnR5X"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"六、删除图片背景","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWUOskAQmYSGO7xkQzx5EF1"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT还具有一些简单的图片处理功能,例如“抠图”功能,即将图片的背景删除,下面介绍具体的操作方法。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnS2SGQIy86oc6SIE4AALkef"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:选中图片,切换至“图片工具-格式”选项卡,在“调整”选项组中单击“删除背景”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn8OIwA4ueGKyAfaUIQFocKl"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:功能区左侧新增一个“背景消除”选项卡,图片周围出现8个控制点,并且背景变为紫色。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWmSgMK4gicaEkj4tNE5Zjb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤3:将光标移到下方中间的控制点上,按住鼠标左键向下拖动鼠标,调整保留的区域。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnw2soY2m040sYs1Sz5DKZAg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤4:若调整控制点后仍有一部分不在保留区域,则可以单击“标记要保留的区域”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnEAIwCSQUW0S86XehRWB6Nc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤5:鼠标光标变为笔样式,然后单击鼠标标记要保留的区域。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnSU6o6gmaE8IAGA1CdJS1Jd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤6:标记完成后,单击“保留更改”按钮。可以看到图片的背景已经被删除,只保留了主体部分。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnIMaCieuGm0wwYHSfXRmKod"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"提示:","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"若用户需要删除多余的标记,则可以单击“删除标记”按钮,此时该按钮处于选中状态,然后在多余的标记上单击鼠标左键,即可将其删除,删除完成后再次单击“删除标记”按钮退出即可。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcngQcsEQSe6GIK4Utfh5SBve"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":1},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"表格与图表","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnC0YkO8GI4gkgUn5xKZmi2f"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"用户在制作分析类演示文稿时,可以使用表格来对数据进行分析和管理,在幻灯片中插入表格的方法有多种,如插入固定行和列的表格、插入指定表格、插入Excel表格等,本节将对其进行详细介绍。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnGOo4GUokme4o4fQ5Z9byeh"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"在PPT中插入表格","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnquWGQ8cca68IsVX5e2Ntid"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、插入固定行数、列数的表格","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnmsGeoQyEUEuuOQUMZA2pLc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在“表格”列表中滑动鼠标,可以直接插入表格,但最多只能创建8行10列之内的表格。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn0KwkywCqEQimY4SWvEoXeI"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:选择幻灯片,切换至“插入”选项卡,单击“表格”下拉按钮,在展开的列表中滑动鼠标,选取8行10列的表格。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnC8aAsEoAQmUqa2Zj9hmuK4"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1031,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"在PPT中插入表格","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/cc72b2d64eff418e85df8eb504dfcd65","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnQMOQK2e4kKq4kBr1brKP3d"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:选取完成后单击鼠标,即可插入。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn0UIksWIWq4S8OwbSgtnhud"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1027,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"在PPT中插入表格","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/8aa65294794d4e9db389fd1fc01c16fe","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnUUaW4YY6OoSCczegOn6QSb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤3:调整表格的大小和位置,然后在其中输入数据即可。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnYQ2Wec8g8CqYWHZeG1aBJf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、插入指定的表格","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnYYIQok6w8SeycTaNWr0SPd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"如果第一种方法满足不了需求,还可以通过对话框插入表格,具体操作方法如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn288qE2U6QQMg6q1kqoRqNf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:选择幻灯片,切换至“插入”选项卡,单击“表格”下拉按钮,从列表中选择“插入表格”选项。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnMkQeq4kYEEmKG6dnQDUU9e"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:打开“插入表格”对话框,输入“列数”和“行数”数值,单击“确定”按钮。幻灯片中随即插入一个5列10行的表格。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnUMkO2kiEaSWCU8AyqVntpO"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤3:调整表格的大小和位置,输入数据内容即可。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnKiKMSw266sSicxjXTKa0Kg"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"对表格进行编辑","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcniUo0MCecWq8a6bQmw5KC2N"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在插入表格后,用户可以根据需要对表格进行编辑,例如设置文本对齐方式、调整行高和列宽、拆分或合并单元格等,下面将分别对其进行详细介绍。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn8koiMSG2MkyawDnQAxXs9f"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、设置文本对齐方式","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnAukeeCyKaOuEicly67DxNh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:选中表格,切换至“表格工具-布局”选项卡,在“对齐方式”选项组中单击“居中”按钮。可以看到表格中的文本内容已经水平居中显示。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn0sOo0WSYMQ2seEwFYlNz3b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:在“对齐方式”选项组中单击“垂直居中”按钮。可以看到表格中的文本内容已经垂直居中显示。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn4eaSkEqWgYmwI1Xirno37b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"提示:","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"用户也可以在“开始”选项卡中单击“段落”选项组中的“居中”按钮,将文本设置为水平居中。单击“对齐文本”下拉按钮,从列表中选择“中部对齐”选项,可以将文本设置为垂直居中显示。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcngoqiQMM84QIkqqFhbdR8Pb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、调整行高和列宽","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcngiySAA0cy0UaSazE4jIFNd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在表格中输入数据后,因为数据类型的差异,所以需要调整某行或某列的高度和宽度,使表格看起来更美观、协调。下面将介绍表格行高和列宽的调整操作:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnYO4ykSiqEquQovDiA2CRZd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:调整列宽。将光标移至需要调整列宽的列右侧边线上,光标变为双箭头形状。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnGU8smyWMsiyc2VgoUyCI4b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:按住鼠标左键不放,拖动鼠标,光标下方出现一条虚线。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnAGYeIuIeWi86ioag0U8W6b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤3:拖动鼠标将虚线移到合适位置后松开,可以调整列宽。按照同样的方法,调整其他列的宽度。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnkGwSCe2GgYqwI37VisNsRc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"三、拆分或合并单元格","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnsGOUGQUQQQoEOQ1HL8qo0g"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"为了使表格中的数据能够合理分布,用户需要对单元格进行合并或拆分,下面介绍具体的操作方法:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcncy48mCOm86coETDmJLRXJd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:合并单元格。选中需要合并的单元格区域,切换至“表格工具-布局”选项卡,单击“合并单元格”按钮。选中的单元格区域随即被合并成一个单元格。按照同样的方法,合并其他单元格区域。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnCiogyO6yuCo4MXhAJJgYFd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤3:拆分单元格。选中需要拆分的单元格,在“布局”选项卡中单击“拆分单元格”按钮。打开“拆分单元格”对话框,在“列数”和“行数”微调框中输入数值,单击“确定”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnuAkc6mEkea6kYJLOUEoIIh"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"对表格进行美化","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnK60ig6Uu0uiQItdCDWaymf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在幻灯片中创建的表格是自带表格样式的。如果想要更改表格样式,使其看起来更加美观,则可以使用内置样式美化表格,或自定义表格样式。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnmcKSu4MQ8wSI4cJMuZnXAb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、使用表格内置样式","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnQaAsGs4GGMEcQB994bcVxb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:选中表格,切换至“表格工具-设计”选项卡,单击“表格样式”选项组中的“其他”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnYiAemMOiQoGuE0txY9M6MS"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:从展开的列表中选择合适的表格样式,可以选择“中度样式3-强调6”选项,可以看到表格应用了所选的样式。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnq6IQQK4Si2UgK8vm88KNif"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"提示:","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"如果用户想要清除应用的表格样式,则可以在“表格样式”下拉列表中选择“清除表格”选项即可。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcncwYksimY8GaKgttNW7K4Kc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、自定义表格样式","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnuaOKUMyE408iEJwODKCf7g"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"如果内置的表格样式无法满足需求,则可以自定义表格样式。例如,设置表格的边框、底纹等,下面对其进行详细介绍。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn0SysQEymGAIke0xmFXNbTd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:选中表格,在“表格工具-设计”选项卡中单击“绘制边框”选项组中的“笔划粗细”下拉按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcniGKK2KugQciWkHgl5qx7Qc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:从展开的列表中选择“3.0磅”选项。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnSCMYMu2EKQ04fc3ai1xADp"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤3:在“绘制边框”选项组中单击“笔颜色”下拉按钮,从列表中选择合适的颜色。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnmqOk08k2GAC4AZ5HNX0SNd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"提示:","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"在幻灯片中,用户还可以使用图表来展示数据,它使复杂的数据关系变得可视化、形象化,并且增强了幻灯片的感染力。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcny2iGEaqgemUey2pxnmfAOh"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"图表另类画法","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnymaWu2uQqMKYuIECDyYIgc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"如果用户觉得创建的图表千篇一律,不能引起观众的兴趣,则可以在基础图表上增加一点创意,这样图表就能变得妙趣横生,让人眼前一亮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnw2Mk8kg2CkEyMfhjkgwwyg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"用户可以使用图片填充功能,制作出创意条形图,下面介绍具体的操作步骤:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnGWKAqQiwg2CmMXh67SlJIh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤1:在“插入”选项卡中单击“图表”按钮,打开“插入图表”对话框,选择“条形图”选项,并在右侧选择“簇状条形图”类型,单击“确定”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnicgIk44qaE6yQ5tzXgjBnc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤2:在打开的Excel电子表格中输入相关数据,单击“关闭”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnKWoQ6suG6MYiQzK8mQSvew"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤3:幻灯片中随即创建一个簇状条形图。选中条形图,在“设计”选项卡中单击“添加图表元素”下拉按钮,从列表中选择“坐标轴→主要横坐标轴”选项,隐藏横坐标轴。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn0Q4cae4ikuSis7N7WhBFcg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤4:在“添加图表元素”下拉列表中选择“网格线→主轴主要垂直网格线”选项,隐藏图表的网格线。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnso2KmYaiEUeYmmJCGd08Df"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤5:选中垂直坐标轴,单击鼠标右键,从弹出的快捷菜单中选择“设置坐标轴格式”命令。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnOwmuoo2640ssOSeb3nMe5d"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤6:弹出“设置坐标轴格式”窗格,切换至“坐标轴选项”选项卡,在“刻度线”选项组中单击“主刻度线类型”右侧的下拉按钮,从列表中选择“无”选项。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn4e4GiCegCKI646a3lYBcxc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤7:关闭窗格,查看设置的效果。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnkqusqMsQcucYOUPBoEcd2e"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤8:选中“步行”系列数据点,单击鼠标右键,从弹出的快捷菜单中选择“设置数据点格式”命令。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnkC0UOUWcCQaocZjTxvURhc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤9:打开“设置数据点格式”窗格,切换至“填充与线条”选项卡,在“填充”组中选中“图片或纹理填充”单选按钮,然后单击下方的“文件”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnYC0M86iKGOcCSscAbG211c"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤10:打开“插入图片”对话框,选择合适的图片,然后单击“插入”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcns0eWIaMGSG2cUpc3oPtbPd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤11:此时,可以看到图片被填充到被选中的柱形中,但该图片已严重变形。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnY6i0guM6y4Swq44CzkEUXg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤12:再次打开“设置数据点格式”窗格,在“填充”选项组中选中“层叠”单选按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnyg2yUIQMekkQg9ZmyWCOwe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤13:此时,可以看到填充的图片恢复到原来的比例。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnI88gIMm8WyKKCkNirnWIDb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤14:按照同样方法,填充其他系列数据点,并删除图例,输入图表标题,添加数据标签等。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcneMqG0OgwSiA8kTqsiiLnDh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤15:选中图表,在“格式”选项卡中单击“形状样式”选项组中的“形状填充”下拉按钮,从列表中选择合适的填充颜色。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnOMeUciWG8KumkxJsVePyxc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步骤16:查看设置好簇状条形图的最终效果。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnoKUIioQyC6uMOWQkvWKQCf"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":1},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"添加音频视频","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcngeca0U8kcAImQX8jnCJSph"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"声音的插入与调整","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn6a8I2sGQWoK6WQHYBYycAd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在制作演示文稿的过程中,特别是在制作商务方面的宣传演示文稿时,可以为幻灯片添加一些合适的声音,添加的声音可以配合图文,使演示文稿变得有声有色,更具感染力。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnkEKwksiEYEEIsr0womw8Bg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、常见的音频格式","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnMuI6cQ4cciOyqww0BuNkMc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT中常用WAV、MP3和MIDI等格式。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnOIeCygiEIAUwYZ3uM6yBNd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(1)WAV格式。WAV格式是Microsoft公司开发的一种声音文件格式,用于保存Windows平台的音频信息资源,被Windows平台及其应用程序所支持,支持多种音频位数、采样频率和声道,是目前计算机上广为流行的声音文件格式,几乎所有的音频编辑软件都识别WAV格式。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnOsASCMUyu0CmGQ11Z3C6Me"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(2)MP3格式。MP3格式诞生于20世纪80年代的德国,所谓的MP3是指MPEG标准中的音频部分,也就是MPEG音频层。MPEG音频文件的压缩是一种有损压缩,牺牲了声音文件中的12kHz~16kHz之间高音频部分的质量来压缩文件的大小。相同时间的音乐文件,用MP3格式存储,一般只有WAV文件的1/10,而音质要次于CD格式或WAV格式声音文件。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnk8cm0GksomqactzmIYc6Nh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(3)MIDI格式。MIDI即音乐设备数字接口(MusicalInstrumentDigitalInterface)的英文缩写,是20世纪80年代初为解决电声乐器之间的通信问题而提出的。MIDI传输的不是声音信号,而是音符、控制参数等指令、MIDI文件本身并不包含波形数据,所以MIDI文件非常小巧,非常适合作为网页的背景音乐。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnAOoaisKqeKKA62qgp59joh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、添加各类声音","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnOGqUmEQkwaaUW80QEH0KSb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"添加文件中的声音就是将计算机中已存在的声音插人到演示文稿中,也可以从其他的声音文件中添加用户需要的声音。具体方法如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcns64kKAUwiQUiOkW2OBLAOb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(1)打开“XXX.pptx”,切换至“插入”面板,在“媒体”选项组中单击“音频”的下三角按钮,在弹出的列表框中选择“PC上的音频”选项。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnECCiyGI4Q82Mg7En9k03de"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(2)弹出“插入音频”对话框,选择素材文件夹下的“bgmusicl.mp3”声音文件,单击“插入”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnQc4s4wQMs4S9tYXCEKswms"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(3)执行操作后,可以拖曳声音图标至合适位置,按〈F5〉键后幻灯片播放,单击播放按钮就可以听到插入的声音。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcni2WeIwUeaq2YWYhelkkYDe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(4)选择音频文件,执行“音频格式”→“播放”命令,打开“播放”面板,设置“开始”为“单击时”,按〈F5〉键后幻灯片播放,音乐将自动播放。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn66wimCQYwMkwCUlE3mcsmc"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"设置声音属性","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnCeWU04gC2GkSkgWj4XDqRD"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"打开PowerPoint,选择需要插入的音频文件,切换至“音频格式”→“播放”面板,可设置音频的相关播放属性。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn8uAyM6AK8Yyw8h2rXpFzIg"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"添加视频","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn4AoAOI422aWuS2oMCAOhWd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"PowerPoint2013中的视频包括视频和动画,可以在幻灯片中插入的视频格式有十几种,PowerPoint支持的视频格式会随着媒体播放器的不同而不同,用户可从剪辑管理器或从外部文件添加视频。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnmwGgimSkc4UKYBD6ZKbqdh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、常见的视频格式","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnqiGYEI08YmOew5VcbXrJze"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT中常插入的视频格式包括AVI、WMV、MPEG、MOV及SWF等。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnI0C0Cmc6IEu4crvtWSdSHb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(1)AVI格式。AVI格式即音频视频交错格式(AudioVideoInterleaved)的英文缩写,是Microsoft公司开发的一种视频文件格式。所谓音频视频交错,是指可以将视频和音频交织在一起进行同步播放。这种视频格式的优点是图像质量好,可以跨平台使用;缺点是体积过于庞大,而且压缩标准不统一,时常会出现视频编码原因而造成视频不能播放等问题。用户如果遇到了这些问题,可以通过下载相应的解码器来解决。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn4ckou6IO8sMII1GBDYew0c"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(2)MOV格式。MOV即QuickTime影片格式,它是Apple公司开发的一种音频、视频文件格式,用于存储常用数字媒体类型。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcneASeSyYsgICWoV2w2P5mCe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(3)MPEG格式。MPEG即运动图像专家组格式(MovingPictureExpertGroup)的英文缩写,日常生活中用户欣赏的VCD、DVD就是这种格式,今天常用的有MP4格式。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnOSKOo4uWy0gygPlylMT0Kg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(4)WMV格式。WMV即视窗媒体视频(WindowsMediaVideo)的英文缩写,是Microsoft公司推出的一种采用独立编码方式并且可以直接在网上实时观看的视频文件压缩格式。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnUIMgeCkE4QWy8UN4fcXxOh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(5)SWF格式。SWF(ShockWaveFlash)是ADOBE公司的动画设计软件Flash的专用格式,是一种支持矢量和点阵图形的动画文件格式,被广泛应用于网页设计、动画制作等领域,SWF文件通常也被称为Flash文件。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnOIeG4MCC2oYyqcxNsYoPkg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、添加文件中的视频","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnUCYsUckgIyOaYVVAiUPHwd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"添加文件中的视频就是将计算机中已存在的视频插人到演示文稿中。具体方法如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWUkuK8UaCkUe8dQWiv0b5c"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(1)打开“视频的使用.pptx”文件,切换至“插入”面板,在“媒体”选项组中单击“视频”的下三角按钮,在弹出的列表框中选择“PC上的视频”选项。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn0S0AI6MKOWyqesqbBCnyxc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(2)弹出“插入视频”对话框,选择素材文件夹下的“视频样例.wmv”声音文件,单击“插人”按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnwg4cUMo8SisYMJsD23pUCf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(3)执行操作后,可以拖曳声音图标至合适位置,按〈FS〉键后幻灯片播放,单击播放按钮即可播放视频。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnSucisuC2mqsC6ilVtSwUHh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"三、设置视频属性","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnkM0ymeeoakWSujzu1A7X2z"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在幻灯片中选中插入的视频,切换至“播放”面板,其中“视频选项”选项组中的各页与“音频”选项组中的各选项作用类似,用户可根据需要设置各选项。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnqAMm2SM0WO2uyi2t44gqEe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"打开PowerPoint2013,选择需要插入的视频文件,切换至“视频工具”→“格式”,可设置视频的相关格式属性。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnwOSMEwYKuaiSKODadL0tUc"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":1},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"动画设置方法","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnCMIGE68ue6K88nRY4ZyDdf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"人类对运动与变化具有天生的敏感。不管这个运动有多么微不足道,变化多么微小,都会强烈地抓住人们的视线。PPT动画的根本在于因内容而变化。对内容的表现力越强,动画效果就越成功。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnmkKsqIYqq6i2yE7P8wcuVh"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"动画的分类","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnyyS0u2EGQWuCiE9y7tOAkf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在PowerPoint中,所谓动画效果主要分为进入动画、强调动画、退出动画和动作路径动画四类,此外,还包括幻灯片切换动画,从而实现了用户对幻灯片中的文本、图形、表格等对象添加不同的动画效果。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcng4A8OaoKGGK0iE9VhbHetd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、进入动画。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"进入动画是对象从“无”到“有”。在触发动画之前,被设置为“进人”动画的对象是不出现的,在触发之后,那它或它们采用何种方式出现,就是“进入”动画要解决的问题。比如设置对象为“进入”动画中的“擦除”效果,可以实现对象从某--方向一点点地出现的效果。进入动画PPT中一般都是使用绿色图标标识。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnyoKakOoe0CKOEfTmpOU7nf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、强调动画。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"强调动画是对象从“有”到“有”,前面的“有”是对象的初始状态,后面的“有”是对象的变化状态。两个状态的变化,起到了对对象强调突出的目的。比如设置对象为“强调动画”中的“变大/变小”效果,可以实现对象从小到大(或设置从大到小)的变化过程,从而产生强调的效果。进入动画PPT中一般都是使用黄色图标标识。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnek4Kwk4giEsq8cMZvgVlNb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"三、退出动画。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"退出动画与进入动画正好相反,它可以使对象从“有”到“无”。触发后的动画效果与“进入”效果正好相反,对象在没有触发动画之前,是存在屏幕上,而当其被触发后,则从屏幕上以某种设定的效果消失。如设置对象为退出动画中的“切出”效果,则对象在触发后会逐渐地从屏幕上某处切出,从而消失在屏幕上。退出动画PPT中一般都是使用红色图标标识。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnoYiIOKA0IKKq0yZ1SANbAy"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"四、动作路径动画。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"就是对象沿着某条路径运动的动画,在PPT中也可以制作出同样的效果,就是将对象设置成“动作路径”效果。比如设置对象为“动作路径”中的“向右”效果,则对象在触发后会沿着设定的方向线移动。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn822mK8e8ugAoGuYZsPPtAc"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"动画的操控方法","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcne2IMu2kSa0kQyILxmGXjEh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"选择设置动画的对象,在“动画窗格”中,选择一个动画,单击右边的下拉箭头,弹出的下拉菜单。单击“计时”选项中的“开始”按钮,会弹出下拉列表框。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnMWqEg4cgOWWmGOQLvBeR3g"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、单击开始。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"只有在多单击一次鼠标之后该动画才会出现。例如想要让两个对象逐一顺序显示,单击一次出现一个,再单击一次再出现一个,那么两个出现动作都应该选择“单击开始”动作选项。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcneEQKGOSGy620LL2hObcYt6"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、从上一项开始。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"该动作会和上一个动作同时开始。例如把第一个对象设置为“单击开始”,第二个对象设置为“从上一项开始”,那么单击一次之后,两个对象的动画会同时进行。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn04AMYo0YW6M0h8t4yAlKFk"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"三、从上一项之后开始。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"上一动画执行完之后该动作就会自动执行。对于两个对象,如果第二个对象选择了这个选项,那么只需单击一次,两个对象的动画就会先后逐一进行。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnQ6uM4wmUEWIiwjEPpXzG0b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"四、效果选项。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"单击会打开“效果”选项卡。在这里,可以对动作的属性进行调整。对于不同的动作,此选项卡的内容会有些差别。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnU6qaAyqYQak4OIoym4kCRb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"最后是给各位职场人士的提示,千万不要为了追求PPT的美观而忽略了其内容的重要性,建议在掌握PPT设计技能前,将重点放在内容表达上,利用常规的PPT操作做出满足职场要求的作品才是正道。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnuM6oCGMOqy2mSc6tJPL7cd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcni24qeo44OA2sueJhxJhU6g"}]%3C%2Fhowto_content%3E2. 我的世界1.7.10nel物品管理器
点击图标,选择安装程序,按照提示选择下一步下一步继续,填入激活码,即可完成安装。
3. 我的世界1.7.10jei物品管理器
有很多人都不知道mc里面怎么炼钢,就导致没法玩各种工业mod,但是,炼钢其实很简单
/gamemode 1
准备mod(带前置):核电工艺 通用机械 高级火箭 科技复兴
先来说核电工艺
可以用钢粒或钢块合成
需要准备铁锭和煤炭
首先你需要制作小制造机:
四角放铅锭(烧铅矿),中间是活塞,四边是铜螺线管
铜螺线管:
4铜锭2铁锭
做出了小制造机,你需要将煤炭丢进去得到石墨粉,再将石墨粉再次丢进小制造机获得石墨锭
有了石墨锭,你就可以制作钢了!
然而你需要一个合金炉
合金炉:
四铁锭中间小制造机四基础版
你现在需要制作这个 又黑又绿 的基础版
基础版:
2铅锭2石墨粉即可
为合金炉通上电,放入铁锭和石墨锭,就可以变成钢锭了!
再来说通用机械
和核电工艺一样,可以用钢粒或钢块合成(我tm有钢锭才能做这些)
需要钢粉在熔炉中烧炼
钢粉又要怎么来呢?
通电后左侧放煤炭,放上富集铁
如果你要问:富集铁咋造?冶金灌注机咋造?
富集铁需要把铁锭放进冶金灌注机内(也是用煤炭)
冶金灌注机:
中间的是锇锭,挖锇矿烧制获得
我认为通用机械炼钢比核电工艺更简单
现在说高级火箭
依然可以用钢块或钢粒合成
也可以用钢粉在熔炉烧制
首先你需要制作电弧高炉
电弧高炉:
看下面
用户界面:
2黄绿染料2萤石粉1玻璃板1红石
物品IO芯片版:
2红石1钻石1木台阶1铁板4金粉
控制芯片版:
2红石1钻石1木台阶1铁板4铜粉
隔热砖:
2岩浆膏4砖块
机器搭建方法:
1层:
5x5隔热砖
2层:
隔热砖3x3+1电弧高炉+11输入/出口
注:输入口和输出口必须各有一个
3层:
5x4-4隔热砖(周围一圈)
4层:
3x4隔热砖+3任意线圈
5层:
6隔热砖+3能量输入口
搭建完毕!
给三个能量输入口通电,把电弧高炉界面右上房的红按钮按成绿按钮
往输入口放进铁锭+木炭,等300秒即可。
最后就是科技复兴了
不知道为啥科技复兴没法用钢块合成了
你可以用 匠魂中的冶炼炉 用熔融钢1锭/144mb在锭铸模上形成
但是要用科技复兴自己的机器造钢好像有点难……
你需要一个叫Industrial Blast Furnace的玩意儿
不过这玩意儿要和其他东西建成一个多方块结构
我 也 不 会 造 这 个 多 方 块 结 构
所以科技复兴就再见吧
个人认为难度对比: 高级火箭>核电工艺>通用机械(科技复兴不会造所以没有)
你已经有了三种炼钢方式,希望你在生存中再也不会缺钢锭了!
至于线圈,输入/输出口,能量输入口的合成表可以自行使用JEI物品管理器mod查询。
4. 我的世界1.12.2jei物品管理器
可能是管理器连接出现问题或者是网络卡住了。
5. 我的世界1.12.2物品管理器
别急,当初不见小喇叭的时候因为你的声音控制程序可能不小心被你删了,你就从别人的电脑C:\WINDOWS\system32这个文件夹里拷贝一个叫 sndvol32.exe的文件放到你的system32里就可以了。然后在控制面板里选“声音和音频设备”,选中“把音量图标放入任务栏”。再刷新。
ok!看任务栏上是不是出现小喇叭了。
现在问题严重了,说明你的system32里被你删除了更多的东西,我想你可以和别人的电脑的system32对照下看缺少了什么应该可以解决的呢。
6. 我的世界1.16.5物品管理器
凿子原版没有,需要加MOD
如果只加凿子一个MOD,那么会有三种凿子:
铁,钻石,黑曜石
(其实功能都一样,就是耐久不一样)
首先拿出三个木棍,一个铁锭,一个钻石,一个黑曜石
然后,在合成空间的某一格放上木棍,在他的右上方向一格距离放上凿子头(铁,钻石,黑曜石)
然后在右边把成型拿出来就可以了(还不会就加物品管理器或者合成内置表)
如果有更多凿子拓展,就会有更多凿子,把凿子头换上想要的材质就可以了,凿子手柄一直都是木棍
7. 我的世界1.7.10nei物品管理器前置
最下面中间那个输入框看到了吗,那里有两个字母ds,用鼠标点击输入框,把字母删掉
这个是搜索框,如果你在里面写了东西,nei会自动筛选出有这个关键字的物品,其他的都会自动隐藏起来
8. 我的世界1.7.10nei物品管理器怎么换作弊模式
1.在创造模式的存档里,按一下键盘的ESC,然后跳出菜单。点一下开启局域网,然后再点一下开启作弊,最后再点开启局域网。
2.然后按/或者按T,/就是右shift左边的按键,按好了然后输入gamemode0意思就是游戏模式,0代表的是生存,1代表的是创造,2代表的是冒险,3代表的是旁观者模式。
3.生存模式就是不能敲方块,只能用工具敲方块。
4.旁观者模式就是可以附身到动物或者玩家身上,以那个人的视角看。还有在旁观者模式可以随意穿墙。
5.或者可以装一些NEI物品管理器一些修改器,也可以直接修改模式的,但是需要开启作弊。
9. 我的世界1.7.10nei物品管理器怎么用
随着计算机应用技术的飞速发展,计算机辅助设计已经成为现代工业设计的重要组成部分,AutoCAD软件具有操作简单、功能强大等特点,它已被广泛应用于机械设计,建筑设计,电子等图形设计领域,那么怎样才能学习好AutoCAD绘图呢?
学前准备
CAD软件选择
在正式学习之前,我们先要做一步准备工作,就是找到一款属于自己的CAD软件。
虽然现在市面上CAD有很多盗版可以使用,但是建议大家使用正版的CAD软件,一是设计者都应该有支持正版的意识,另一方面就是正版软件会减少很多后顾之忧,相对来说会更加安全。
建议可以选择CAD2004、CAD2007等,这些老一点的版本是经过多次修正过的,在技术、用户体验方面要比新的版本好用。
认识操作界面
关于【应用程序菜单】
用于访问“应用程序”菜单中的常用工具以启动或发布文件。
单击“应用程序”按钮,以执行以下操作:
1、创建、打开或保存文件;
2、核查、修复和清除文件;
3、打印或发布文件;
4、访问“选项”对话框;
5、关闭应用程序;
注:也可以通过双击“应用程序”按钮关闭应用程序。
关于【快速访问工具栏】
使用“快速访问”工具栏显示经常使用的工具。
【查看放弃和重做历史记录】与大多数程序一样,“快速访问”工具栏会显示用于放弃和重做对工作所做更改的选项。要放弃或重做不是最新的修改,请单击“放弃”或“重做”按钮右侧的下拉按钮。
【添加命令和控件】通过单击指示的下拉按钮并单击下拉菜单中的选项,可轻松将常用工具添加到“快速访问”工具栏。
注:要快速将功能区按钮添加到“快速访问”工具栏,请在功能区的任何按钮上单击鼠标右键,然后单击“添加到快速访问工具栏”。
关于【功能区】
功能区按逻辑分组来进行工具排序。功能区由多个功能选项卡组成,每点击一个选项卡,下方则会对应展示出一个功能面板,面板包括了对创建和修改图形需要的工具。
【功能区选项卡和面板】功能区由一系列选项卡组成,这些选项卡被组织到面板,其中包含很多工具栏中可用的工具和控件。
一些功能区面板提供了对与该面板相关的对话框的访问。要显示相关的对话框,请单击面板右下角处由箭头图标表示的对话框启动器。
注:您可以控制显示哪些功能区选项卡和面板。在功能区上单击鼠标右键,然后单击或清除快捷菜单上列出的选项卡或面板的名称。如下图:显示和隐藏【默认选项卡】
【浮动面板】您可以将面板从功能区选项卡中拉出,并放到绘图区域中或其他监视器上。浮动面板将一直处于打开状态(即使切换功能区选项卡),直到您将其放回到功能区。
【滑出式面板】如果您单击面板标题中间的箭头,面板将展开以显示其他工具和控件。默认情况下,当您单击其他面板时,滑出式面板将自动关闭。要使面板保持展开状态,请单击滑出式面板左下角的图钉图标。
关于【命令栏】
程序的核心部分是“命令”窗口,它通常固定在应用程序窗口的底部。“命令”窗口可显示提示、选项和消息。
您可以直接在“命令”窗口中输入命令,而不使用功能区、工具栏和菜单。许多长期用户更喜欢使用此方法。
注:开始键入命令时,它会自动完成。当提供了多个可能的命令时,您可以通过单击或使用箭头键并按Enter键或空格键来进行选择。
关于【状态栏】
名词解释:状态栏显示光标位置、绘图工具以及会影响绘图环境的工具。
状态栏提供对某些最常用的绘图工具的快速访问。您可以切换设置(例如,夹点、捕捉、极轴追踪和对象捕捉)。您也可以通过单击某些工具的下拉箭头,来访问它们的其他设置。
注:默认情况下,不会显示所有工具,您可以通过状态栏上最右侧的按钮,选择您要从“自定义”菜单显示的工具。状态栏上显示的工具可能会发生变化,具体取决于当前的工作空间以及当前显示的是“模型”选项卡还是布局选项卡。
您还可以使用键盘上的功能键(F1–F12),切换其中某些设置。
关于【快捷菜单】
名词解释:显示快速获取当前动作有关命令的快捷菜单。在屏幕的不同区域内单击鼠标右键时,可以显示快捷菜单。快捷菜单上通常包含以下选项:
1、重复执行输入的上一个命令;
2、取消当前命令;
3、显示用户最近输入的命令的列表;
4、剪切、复制以及从剪贴板粘贴;
5、选择其他命令选项;
6、显示对话框,例如“选项”或“自定义”;
7、放弃输入的上一个命令;
显示快捷菜单的步骤
在图形中的对象或区域、菜单中的按钮或功能区中单击鼠标右键。
在绘图区域,单击鼠标右键
在某些定点设备上,可能需要按住相应的按钮。注:显示与光标位置相关的快捷菜单。
学习步骤
学习CAD制图,我们从浅入深可分3个阶段进行。
掌握基础操作
熟悉CAD的绘图命令、掌握CAD软件操作逻辑。这就像我们学认字、写字一样,先掌握基础的笔画、笔顺开始。
制图常用的基本命令1
CAD绘图命令:
CAD修改命令:
CAD尺寸标注命令:
视窗缩放:
对象特性:
常用CTRL快捷键:
常用功能键:
制图常用的基本命令2
1、绘图栏上数下第一命令是——直线,快捷键L,不分大小写。直线命令是我们最常用的命令,也是绘图的基础中的基础。若要绘制直线,请单击“直线”工具;
在绘图区域用鼠标左键单击一次,其目的是为了指定直线线段的第一个起点;松开鼠标,往任意方向拖动,线段会跟着拖动幅度变长变短;
这时,我们会看见直线的旁边有一个白色的输入框,里面的数值会随着我们的拖动幅度而变化,这里面的数值代表是直线的长度,我们可以在里面输入任意数值确定直线长度,然后按Enter或者空格键完成一条直线的绘制。
2、第二个命令是——构造线。快捷键XL,它是为下一步的复制,镜象等作为基准的直线,虚线不属于图的轮廓线,一般是作为图形某一点为中心的轴线。若要绘制构造线,方法如下:
在绘图工具中点击构造线工具。
依次在绘图板中点击一下鼠标可见构造线。
3、第三个命令是——多段线。快捷键PL,它由多条线段(可以是直线,也可以是弧线)组成一个整体的线段。如想选中该线段中的一部分,必须先将其分解。平常作图经常用到,就连做地形图时也需要它,所以是很重要的命令。
要绘制多段线,输入多段线命令敲击多段线命令PL,敲击空格键。
绘制多段线在CAD绘图区指定直线的起点,输入多段线的长度,敲击空格键即可。
4、第四个命令是——正多边形。快捷键POL,顾名思义是可以绘制多边形,点击命令,输入边的数量,然后选择内切圆或者外切圆,就可以绘制了。绘制步骤如下:
1/5要绘制正多边形,需要输入命令:“POL”-“空格”,也可以在顶部的选项卡中找相应的按钮点击,但是有点麻烦。
2/5命令行这个时候会提醒你:输入侧面数。这个侧面数的意思,就是多边形的边数,几个侧面,就是几边形。这里输入6。
3/5接下来就是按照提示:指定多边形的中心,这个应该好理解,可以通过鼠标点选,或者键盘输入坐标的方式来指定中心。
4/5命令行提示:内接于圆,或者外切于圆。因为AutoCAD表征多变形的特征是通过内接圆/外切圆的直径来的,所以这里要指明。我们选外切圆。
5/5这个时候,就需要指定外切圆的直径了,我们通过鼠标点选的方式来完成指定,就可以绘出正六边形了。
5、第五个命令是——矩形。快捷键REC,可以快速绘制出矩形宽,这个也是很常用的一个命令。
在功能区单击矩形按钮,然后再绘图区域任意处点击,确定矩形的一个角点,然后拖动鼠标,在任意处点击,确定第二个角点位置,这时矩形就绘制完成了。
6、第六个命令是——圆弧。快捷键ARC,绘制圆弧命令可以快速画出弧线,示意门之类的地方很常用。
首先打开软件,然后在命令行输入快捷键命令:ARC,按回车键确认,根据命令行提示在绘图区域指定圆弧的起点或 [圆心(C)],接着继续指定圆弧的第二个点或[圆心(C)/端点(E)],即可完成圆弧的绘制了。如下图所示:
背诵秘籍口诀
1、想到直线就用L+空格
2、想到圆就用C+空格
3、想到圆弧就用A+空格
4、想到矩形就用REC+空格
5、想到点就用PO+空格
6、想到单行文本就用DT
7、想到多行文本就用MT
8、想到填充就用H
9、想到线段延伸到某一线段就用EX+空格
10、想到矩形倒圆角就用F+空格
11、想到修剪绘图过程中多余的线就用TR+空格
12、想到修改文本就用ED+空格
13、想到移动就用M+空格;
14、想到旋转就用RO+空格
15、想到偏移就用O+空格
16、想到镜像就用MI+空格
17、想到复制就用CO+空格
18、想到局部观察平面图细节就用Z+空格
19、想到实时缩放放大镜就用Z+空格+空格
20、想到平移视图就用P+空格
21、想到平移视图平移视图就用P+空格
22、想到返回上一视图就用Z+空格+P+空格
23、想到全局显示自己绘的平面图就用Z+空格+A+空格
24、想到打印文件就用CTRL+P
25、想到复制,就用CTRL+C
26、想到粘贴就用CTRL+V
27、想到剪切就用,CTRL+X代表
28、想到新建文件就用CTRL+N
29、想到寻求帮助时,就用F1
30、想到正交就用F8
31、想到打开和关闭对象捕捉工具就用F3
32、想到直线标注就用DLI+空格
33、想到调整文字样式就用ST+空格
34、想到重新生成就用R+E+空格
35、想要设置捕捉模式就用OS+空格
36、想到重复上一次的操作就用ENTER
37、想到刷新就用RE+空格
38、想到取消正在执行的可用ESC
39、想到设置捕捉模式就用OS
40、想到旋转就用RO
41、想到计算面积就用AA
42、想到平移就用P+空格
43、想到最常用的标注快就用DLI
44、想到直线就用LINE
45、想到圆就用C
46、想到偏移就用O
47、想到修改文本就用ed
基本操作逻辑
一、选择逻辑
如图,这里我绘制了一些直线、圆、矩形。单击其中的一个圆与一条直线,它们变成了被选中的状态。
但是如果元素特别多,那一个一个单击显然不现实,如下图请你一个个单击给我看。
这时候就要用到框选了。在CAD中,框选有两种形式,这里以下面的图为例来解释。
1是从左往右按住鼠标左键框选,此时选框呈蓝色,这种形式下只有框选的图形完全被框住才能被选中。
如图,我完全框住了前三条直线,但第四条没完全框住,此时被选中的只有前三条线。
2是从右往左按住鼠标左键框选,此时选框呈绿色,这种形式下只要接触到被框选的图形,它就会被选中。
同样的,我们从右往左框住前三条线,第四条线只框一半如图,此时即使第四条线没框全,但选框接触到它也能被选中了。
这里插一点,如果你框选以后想取消选择,只需按ESC即可。
如果你只想取消部分图形的选中状态,只需按住shift再将你想取消选择的图形进行框选(逻辑同样是上面两种形式),此时被框中的图形就会取消被选中的状态。
这样的两种框选模式看似简单,但学会实际运用它们是能大大提高你的画图效率的。
下面我举个简单的例子,如图,一个矩形中有许多交叉的直线。如果我只想选中直线的部分,而不想选中矩形怎么办?这里提供两种思路。
1、在矩形内部,从右往左进行框选使选框接触到所有直线,这样即使直线外部未被框柱,所有直线还是会被选中
2、先从左往右把所有元素选中,再按住shift从右往左框选,只接触到外部矩形的部分,将它取消选中状态。
二、键盘命令
取消、删除、撤销、重做。任何绘图软件都离不开以上四种操作,这里我将CAD这四种操作的快捷键告诉大家。
取消:ESC
删除:Delete
撤销:Ctrl+Z(撤销多步就多按几次)
重做:Ctrl+Y(重做一般与撤销搭配使用,如果你撤销多了一步,按重做会回到上一步)
三、鼠标中键
1、双击鼠标中键:显示全部图形对象。
2、按住鼠标中键拖动鼠标:移动图纸
此时十字光标会变成一只小手,你可以通过拖动鼠标来移动图纸。
3、滚动鼠标中键:缩放图纸。这个大家应该都懂,缩放图纸与上面的拖动图纸配合使用,方便你找到图形的位置。
4、命令栏
CAD这个软件,在我看来最重要的就是它的命令栏。
几乎你画在图上的一切东西都与它有关。首先它的位置在之前讲过,位于CAD界面的下方,共两栏。上面一栏表示已结束的命令,下面一栏表示现在的命令。
CAD的命令栏,就相当于一个你的助手,它会指引你做每一步操作。下面举个简单的例子。
如下图,首先我们选择CAD左侧绘图工具中的直线。(可直接键盘上输入L再按空格/回车)此时命令栏第二行提示指定第一个点。
我们在绘图区空白处单击一下,此时命令显示为指定下一点或放弃U。(由于这条线还没画完,此时第一栏并没有内容,即没有上一步命令)此时你再选绘图区另外一点,一条直线就画完了;如果你输入U,则放弃绘制这条直线。
而此时命令栏还是提示指定下一点或放弃。这里你有两种选择。1是单击空格/回车键,则线段绘制完毕。2是继续选择另一点,那么就会出现两条线。
此时命令栏的提示多了一项:闭合C。如果你键盘输入C,则两条线段头尾相接,不在一条直线上则形成三角形。
这里注意两点:
绘制完图形对象后,再单击空格或回车键,即可结束整个命令。如果你想重复上一次的命令,比如想继续画线段,只需再按下空格,会自动重复上一次指令。此时又要开始选择线段的第一个点……
以上牵扯到一个核心的操作逻辑。即CAD的命令栏在你选择完基础命令后一步步指引你进行操作,给你提供多种选择。
即使你对这个命令不熟悉,通过命令栏的提示你也能很快理解。例如刚才举的例子画线段,我们都知道两点确定一线段,因此CAD中绘制线段在命令栏中分两步,分别是确定两个点的位置。
5、状态栏
状态栏位于命令栏下方。
前半部分有一个坐标点的数据,它表示的是十字光标在绘图区的位置,而它的参照物是CAD绘图区的坐标原点,如下图。这里需要注意的是,Z轴的数字一般是0,因为我们主要是绘制平面上的图形。
状态栏重点在于后半部分的几个按钮,掌握它们,你的绘图效率会得到极大的提高。
1、首先说下捕捉模式和栅格显示
它们一般搭配使用,捕捉会自动捕捉最近的栅格点,栅格则是体现在绘图区会出现栅格网,这两个按钮我建议大家关掉,会对绘图的视线造成干扰,同时容易使光标闪烁。
2、接下来是正交模式
开启和关闭它的快捷键是键盘上的F8,经常会用到希望大家记住。
这个模式非常重要。如果你要画直线,希望直线横平竖直,即只在XY方向绘制,那么打开正交模式,所有画出来的线条都会在XY方向。与此相关的是其后的极轴模式。
就是通常的带角度的绘图模式,与正交模式相反。
3、对象捕捉,快捷键F3
这个模式可以极大极大极大极大提高绘图的效率,非常重要!这里先举个简单的例子。
当你绘制出了一个矩形,想选中的它的一个角点往上画别的东西,这个时候把对象捕捉模式打开,那么你会发现,当光标移动到矩形角点附近时,会在角点上出现一个绿色的小框。
此时如果你要再往上画个矩形,那么当你绘制时,你会发现矩形的角点自动吸附到了原矩形的角点上。
因此,对象捕捉模式就像一块磁铁,它能让光标自动吸附到一些特殊的点位上,不仅仅是端点角点。
这里鼠标右键单击对象捕捉,选择设置,里面提供了各种各样的特殊点和延长线等等。这里提醒下大家,千万别全部打开哦,不然会被各种磁铁吸来吸去,眼花缭乱反而降低效率。
4、对象捕捉追踪
设想你要画两条线段,希望它们不仅平行且头尾对齐,该怎么画?
如下图,当你开启对象捕捉追踪后,在绘制第二条线段的第二个点时,先将光标挪到第一条线段的端点上再慢慢往下挪动(不要单击,只是挪动),此时会出现一条绿色的虚线,它就像一把尺子一样能帮助你对齐。
这时将光标慢慢往下挪,单击即可绘制出端点对齐的两条线啦。
掌握绘图基本规范
这个包括标注样式、详图、剖图、引线规范等。这就像学会了写字,组词造句一样。
基本要求
1、所有设计室出的图纸都要配备图纸封皮、图纸说明、图纸目录。
A、图纸封皮须注明工程名称、图纸类别(施工图、竣工图、方案图)、制图日期。
B、图纸说明须对工程进一步说明工程概况、工程名称、建设单位、施工单位、设计单位或建筑设计单位等。
2、每张图纸须编制图名、图号、比例、时间。
3、打印图纸按需要、比例出图。
常用制图方式
一、常用比例
1:1、1:2、1:3、1:4、1:5、1:6、1:10
1:15、1:20、1:25、1:30、1:40、1:50、1:60、1:80
1:100、1:150、1:200、1:250、1:300、1:400、1:500
二、线型
1、粗实线:0.3mm
1)平、剖面图中被剖切的主要建筑构造的轮廓(建筑平面图)。
2)室内外立面图的轮廓。
3)建筑装饰构造详图的建筑物表面线。
2、中实线:0.15-0.18mm
1)平、剖面图中被剖切的次要建筑构造的轮廓线。
2)室内外平顶、立、剖面图中建筑构配件的轮廓线。
3)建筑装饰构造详图及构配件详图中一般轮廓线。
3、细实线:0.1mm
填充线、尺寸线、尺寸界限、索引符号、标高符号、分格线。
4、细虚线:0.1-0.13mm
1)室内平面、顶面图中未剖切到的主要轮廓线。
2)建筑构造及建筑装饰构配件不可见的轮廓线。
3)拟扩建的建筑轮廓线。
4)外开门立面图开门表示方式。
5、细点划线:0.1-0.13mm
中心线、对称线、定位轴线。
6、细折断线:0.1-0.13mm
不需画全的断开界线。
三、打印出图笔号1-10号线宽设置,选择打印,弹出的对话框的右上角有个笔形的图标,点击,出现各种颜色。
10号特粗线:1)立面地坪线2)索引剖切符号3)图标上线
4)索引图标中表示索引图在本图的短线
四、剖切索引符号
1、m:?12mm(在A0、A1、A2、图纸)
2、m:?10mm(在A3、A4图纸)
3、特粗线到索引线为剖视方向
4、A:字高5mm(在A0、A1、A2、图纸),字高4mm(在A3、A4图纸)
5、B-01:字高3mm(在A0、A1、A2、图纸),字高2、5mm(在A3、A4图纸)
6、A为索引图号,B-01为索引图纸号,B-01为“”表示索引在本图
五、平、立面索引符号
1、m:?12mm(在A0、A1、A2、图纸)
2、m:?10mm(在A3、A4图纸)
3、A1-A4:字高4mm(在A0、A1、A2图纸),字高3mm(在A3、A4图纸)
4、B-01--B-04:字高2、5mm(在A0、A1、A2图纸),字高2mm(在A3、A4图纸)
六、大样图索引
大样引出框
1、m:?12mm(在A0、A1、A2图纸)
2、m:?12mm(在A3、A4图纸)
3、A:字高4mm(在A0、A1、A2图纸),字高3mm(在A3、A4图纸)
4、B-01:字高2、5mm(在A0、A1、A2图纸),字高2mm(在A3、A4图纸)
七、图标
1、图名:字高7mm(在A0、A1、A2图纸),字高5mm(在A3、A4图纸)
2、比例及英文图名:字高4mm(在A0、A1、A2图纸),字高3mm(在A3、A4图纸)
八、文字注释
1、引出线为箭头或点,引出线为统一体,由标注命令引线制作。
2、文字说明:字高4mm(在A0、A1、A2图纸),字高3mm(在A3、A4图纸)。
九、标高符号
1、数字:字高2、5mm(在A0、A1、A2图纸),字高2mm(在A3、A4图纸)。
2、符号为等腰直角三角形。
3、数字以m计单位,小数点后留三位。
4、零点标高写成±0、000,正数标高不注“”,负数标高应注“-”。
5、同样位置不同标高标注。
十、轴线符号
1、n:?10mm,字高4mm(在A0、A1、A2图纸)
2、n:?8mm,字高3.5mm(在A3、A4图纸)
十一、尺寸符号
1、尺寸标注是尺寸为统一体,如需调整尺寸数字,可采用edit(ed)命令。
2、尺寸界线距标注物体2-3mm,第一道尺寸线距标注物体10-12mm,相邻的尺寸线间距7-10mm。
3、半径、直径标注时箭头样式为实心闭合箭头。
4、标注字高2.5mm(在A0、A1、A2图纸),字高2mm(在A3、A4图纸)。
5、标注文字距尺寸线1-1.5mm。
制图技巧
一、图层管理
1、一般制图分层
A、墙体层(WALL);B、家具层(FURNITURE);C、填充层;D、窗层(WINDOW);E、布置层;F、尺寸层(DIM);G、文字层(TEXT);H、轴线层(DOTE);轴线标注层(AXIS);J、分格层
制图时分清各层便于调整图纸,节省时间。
2、线条分色
制图时将墙体、家具、填充线、文字、分格线等线条颜色区分,便于在电脑显示时一目了然。
3、图框插入
按比例插入图框
首先制作1:1图框,将图框放大,与图比较看是否配合。如不配合缩放与之配合。如要作1:30的图框,第一次图框放大40后不合适,再次缩放输入3/4,即可得到1:30的图框B。
二、其他
1、CAD文件在从其他文件粘贴进来后,容易出现无用图层,可purge(pu),清理无用图层。
2、文字的大小是根据图纸的比例变化的,如A3图纸,比例为1:50,注释文字打印出的尺寸应该是3mm,在文字制作时,文字尺寸大小输入150。
3、一套图中可能会有不同的比例,在按比例插完第一个图框后,遇到不同比例的图,应根据比例的大小缩放。如有一张图比例为1:50,是正确的,现在要给另一张图插图框,假设这张图要插1:40的图框那就复制1:50的图框,然后缩放输入4/5即得。文字的大小亦可采用这种办法。
4、同一个CAD界面下,如果打开多个CAD文件,可按着ctrl键点Tab键转换,浩辰CAD等可以直接在文件标签栏点文件名进行切换,最新的ACAD2014也加入了类似的功能。
5、在多重复制同一个物体时,可将这一物体作成图块,如果修改了任意一个图块参照,则其他同名图块也随之改变,如不建立图块,则每个都需要修改。
6、建立CAD文件时要有选择的将平面图、立面图、详图分为几个文件。
7、最好不要将图形都花在0层上,0层主要用来定义图块。定义图块时,先将所有图元均设置为0层(有特殊时除外),然后再定义块,这样,在插入块时,插入时是哪个层,块就是那个层了。
8、不能在DEFPOINTS层建立图元,此层默认是不打印的,在图层上的图形会打印不出来。
9、在CAD软件的使用过程中,虽然一直说是画图,但实际上大部分都是在编辑图。因为编辑图元可以大量减少绘制图元不准确的几率,并且可以在一定程度上提高效率。
10、在使用绘图命令时,一定要设置捕捉,F3切换。
11、在使用绘图和编辑命令时,大部分情况下,都要采用正交模式,F8切换。
12、图纸大小:A0—1194*840;A1—840*597;A2—597*420;A3—420*297;A4—297*210。
13、将CAD文件转化成位图文件:
第一种是在CAD的菜单中,选择“输出”,再选择bmp的后缀存储,可以把CAD的屏幕显示内容变成位图文件,但文件分辨率太小。
第二种是将CAD文件转化成为较大分辨率的位图文件。添加一个光栅图像如JPG、TGA、PNG等格式的虚拟打印机。
14、将EXCEL表格倒入CAD可以利用AutoXlsTable插件或是先将EXCEL表格复制,到CAD里的下拉编辑菜单的选择性粘贴即可得,到CAD后将表格炸开后即可CAD修改。
实战演练图纸设计
新手在学习CAD的时候,光掌握了CAD制图方法是不行的,还要勤于练习才行。找一些基础的练习图纸。
小白必备图纸
刚开始接触到CAD的小白,肯定不能上来就直接拿一些复杂结构图纸让他们练习,做任何事都要循序渐进。下面这几张图纸涵盖了CAD机械建筑练习图,以及房屋建筑类的练习图,是CAD小白必备的练习图纸。
基础练习图纸
基础的练习图纸,内容是由简单到复杂,由平面图形再到立体图形的绘制,可以逐步提升绘图能力,特别适合CAD初学者练习使用,下面放出部分的图纸供大家参考。
注意事项
1、学习CAD不要急于求成
CAD的学习过程讲究循序渐进,先了解绘图的基本知识,打好基础,再勤加练习,知识的吸收要由浅及深,由简到繁,这样学习起来不吃力,学习的兴趣也会大一点。
2、不要不遵循作图步骤
在进行CAD绘图的时候最好首先要设置好图幅大小,然后设置单位和精度,根据绘图对象建立好图层,设置好对象样式后才开始绘图。
3、绘图比例乱设置
在进行绘图的时候不要自己随心所欲的设置绘图比例,CAD绘图比例有很多,而每个比例都是科学设置的,最佳绘图比例是1:1,将绘图比例设置为1:1绝对不会错。
4、不要在0层上绘图
这一点是一定要注意的,因为0层是系统默认的图层,不能更名和删除,通常用作草稿图层或插入块,将图画在0层上容易导致图层混乱,不利于分层管理。5、不要把图框和图形画在同一副图中
绘图时如果需要运用到图框应当将图框以块的形式插入进图中,而不是直接画,直接画在后面打印图纸的时候容易出现错乱。
6、遇到问题不及时弄清楚
在绘图时因为操作的原因可能会出现很多问题,遇到问题一定要第一时间搞清楚,因为你记着记着可能就忘了。比如说画一张图,别人画的大小适中,而你画起来图形很小,有的甚至看不见,这可能是因为你没有设置绘图界限而导致的。
7、不设置线型比例
没有设置线型比例可能会导致你用虚线画线但画出来看起来就像是用实线画的,线型比例在设置的时候还要根据图形的尺寸来,如果图形尺寸特别小可以将图形比例设大一点,如果图形尺寸特别大可以将图形比例设小一点。
8、不标注工程信息
工程标注是工程的重要依据。在一幅工程图中工程标注是不可少的重要部分。在某些情况下,工程标注甚至比图形更重要。所以小伙伴们在绘图的时候一定不要忘了标注。
9、文字字体不规范
文字是CAD图纸不可缺少的一部分,如尺寸标注文字、图纸说明等,在标注的时候很多小伙伴都会用自己喜欢的字体,这样是错误的,规范的字体是“长仿宋体”。
%3Chowto_content%3E[{"type":"paragraph","attrs":{"is_abstract":true},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"随着计算机应用技术的飞速发展,计算机辅助设计已经成为现代工业设计的重要组成部分,AutoCAD软件具有操作简单、功能强大等特点,它已被广泛应用于机械设计,建筑设计,电子等图形设计领域,那么怎样才能学习好AutoCAD绘图呢?","id":""}],"text":"","id":"KIgAdG2OEo42wyxkPBBcU7K4nPb"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":1},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"学前准备","id":""}],"text":"","id":"VKsSdimiMowKA6x67zpct5xHnNe"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"CAD软件选择","id":""}],"text":"","id":"D26odu6mwo2gYSxymcecHxfAnhc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在正式学习之前,我们先要做一步准备工作,就是找到一款属于自己的CAD软件。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"DqWydwE8cogAQcxCORjcfz5Gn5b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"虽然现在市面上CAD有很多盗版可以使用,但是建议大家使用正版的CAD软件,一是设计者都应该有支持正版的意识,另一方面就是正版软件会减少很多后顾之忧,相对来说会更加安全。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"BmwEd0m0AoGSC2xyGLUcQpRgnwc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"建议可以选择CAD2004、CAD2007等,这些老一点的版本是经过多次修正过的,在技术、用户体验方面要比新的版本好用。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"UiOUdYIGyoEEQkxGcY8cy1ZEnFc"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":1},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"认识操作界面","id":""}],"text":"","id":"F8I4dsMcwo0iuCxoIV9c7PIQnOT"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"关于【应用程序菜单】","id":""}],"text":"","id":"IamidAsSaokou4xSKU6crmVInzc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"用于访问“应用程序”菜单中的常用工具以启动或发布文件。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"TkC4dGa2uoimwuxqGChck7gnnlf"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":42,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"关于【应用程序菜单】","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/ada696d2c64245ff82c70a0f69382991","width":42},"text":"","id":"JKgwduSCkosKiYxGWAacb86inOd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"单击“应用程序”按钮,以执行以下操作:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"JC4Md6YIIoyU8wx3aVLcJQHBns5"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"1、创建、打开或保存文件;","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Y6CEdSAqoo4eeExyQ9TcQYfDnXb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"2、核查、修复和清除文件;","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Uw48d8qY8oaWI6x4uHbcjb3knAb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"3、打印或发布文件;","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Ce0SdcKwyoK2aWx4gJwcfMUpnxc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"4、访问“选项”对话框;","id":""}],"text":"","id":"VQwwdYIGUoYQMax46lucvxnpnsd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"5、关闭应用程序;","id":""}],"text":"","id":"YYYMd6sGuoiCy4xeCXkc4b46n7g"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"注:也可以通过双击“应用程序”按钮关闭应用程序。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"PI0AdMG8koQqOIxE62QcAzbJnwd"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"关于【快速访问工具栏】","id":""}],"text":"","id":"AkuAduCceoumkUxMTt7c7Qstnqg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"使用“快速访问”工具栏显示经常使用的工具。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"GmiwdQmgMogoQoxMtcycEobsnQb"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":68,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"关于【快速访问工具栏】","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/2de7609a3b7e4a0dbf40e48883edb7ae","width":269},"text":"","id":"SOoWde4GSoO6eSxys9Sc1kPNnhc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"【查看放弃和重做历史记录】与大多数程序一样,“快速访问”工具栏会显示用于放弃和重做对工作所做更改的选项。要放弃或重做不是最新的修改,请单击“放弃”或“重做”按钮右侧的下拉按钮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"GIoydUKsUokMKAxu4hCcZN4nnMf"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":66,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"关于【快速访问工具栏】","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/7b1fef2898434ee9b95143e7aa5db00e","width":267},"text":"","id":"XwYud0YgwoG0AAxCUMhc1g8Jnkf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"【添加命令和控件】通过单击指示的下拉按钮并单击下拉菜单中的选项,可轻松将常用工具添加到“快速访问”工具栏。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"LcacdKug0om0aGxMhYGc74j1nSd"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":66,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"关于【快速访问工具栏】","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/77ec98a6d98e4338a7f4a2bda0cef86d","width":269},"text":"","id":"Qmcwd66UMo2SiCxuIoLcb9U4njc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"注:要快速将功能区按钮添加到“快速访问”工具栏,请在功能区的任何按钮上单击鼠标右键,然后单击“添加到快速访问工具栏”。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"FaugdCwq0ogWIQxEzD2c2HednWf"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":153,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"关于【快速访问工具栏】","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/432d259768a04f01936bfd8b22241608","width":243},"text":"","id":"MYQMd2aQeooUgUxqeEWcheCEnJg"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"关于【功能区】","id":""}],"text":"","id":"ZqGgdomQAoWYAix6SvFccdBSnYf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"功能区按逻辑分组来进行工具排序。功能区由多个功能选项卡组成,每点击一个选项卡,下方则会对应展示出一个功能面板,面板包括了对创建和修改图形需要的工具。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"XQymd240Wom8CAxam5AcRk9knjc"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":123,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"关于【功能区】","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/0256173d622b410db672492a9e27a1e8","width":1123},"text":"","id":"CgWud4aayoYaUWx4nY9c4tecnDh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"【功能区选项卡和面板】功能区由一系列选项卡组成,这些选项卡被组织到面板,其中包含很多工具栏中可用的工具和控件。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"OUkudQCEKo80Mgx2zqMcLgOZnUb"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":293,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"关于【功能区】","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/c05ee3e047db45c693581fc80a403f44","width":1024},"text":"","id":"BECeduuEuoe2KwxkLdacgm8lnCb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"一些功能区面板提供了对与该面板相关的对话框的访问。要显示相关的对话框,请单击面板右下角处由箭头图标表示的对话框启动器。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"CQIadi2cio80UixojTPcSlyhnyd"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":191,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"关于【功能区】","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/60ab16c433f147d6946d4ba3ad86bb02","width":380},"text":"","id":"CQqqdIYG2okiqaxGy0Gckvh6nRP"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"注:您可以控制显示哪些功能区选项卡和面板。在功能区上单击鼠标右键,然后单击或清除快捷菜单上列出的选项卡或面板的名称。如下图:显示和隐藏【默认选项卡】","id":""}],"text":"","id":"TegOdQK00oaQYGxczcfcQMB9nzg"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":725,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"关于【功能区】","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/8c4676fdec2e41c68875c73611c4fdf8","width":1181},"text":"","id":"I8SAdQ0CIoqagkxaO8EcJyBwnGg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"【浮动面板】您可以将面板从功能区选项卡中拉出,并放到绘图区域中或其他监视器上。浮动面板将一直处于打开状态(即使切换功能区选项卡),直到您将其放回到功能区。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"SkK0dqAgCoMIw6x6hDcczdZLn8d"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":119,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"关于【功能区】","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/274e834ef484469296a0c4db4999435c","width":354},"text":"","id":"BqoSdaSuAo6kiuxYFNHccLECnne"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"【滑出式面板】如果您单击面板标题中间的箭头,面板将展开以显示其他工具和控件。默认情况下,当您单击其他面板时,滑出式面板将自动关闭。要使面板保持展开状态,请单击滑出式面板左下角的图钉图标。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"BIsEdGcUwo8Ie8xwzHbcQfP4nvf"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":531,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"关于【功能区】","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/bc74a44a938e4a0ebee2bd07058dfe5f","width":1024},"text":"","id":"SCAsdKwyYoQI4wxm4Pmc7nOpnMg"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"关于【命令栏】","id":""}],"text":"","id":"DYoydGGqAoM2CQx63cscF85Mnvb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"程序的核心部分是“命令”窗口,它通常固定在应用程序窗口的底部。“命令”窗口可显示提示、选项和消息。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"RmWKd6IAmoKYSuxuYclcVm2Vn7f"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":48,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"关于【命令栏】","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/a1a61c87e3ba45cca3d4f31d11de6305","width":440},"text":"","id":"XsG2dQsYCoqykuxGw1rcpNk6neh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"您可以直接在“命令”窗口中输入命令,而不使用功能区、工具栏和菜单。许多长期用户更喜欢使用此方法。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"AgMed6CqIom4GuxsLKtczyN6ncg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"注:开始键入命令时,它会自动完成。当提供了多个可能的命令时,您可以通过单击或使用箭头键并按Enter键或空格键来进行选择。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"GwMwdIUwAoomayxMTbYcd1W5nQg"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"关于【状态栏】","id":""}],"text":"","id":"EMGKdMMM4oukmKx2jhKcHju8n6d"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"名词解释:状态栏显示光标位置、绘图工具以及会影响绘图环境的工具。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"RwgGdqI08oUacwxMHYGcyOGGnfc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"状态栏提供对某些最常用的绘图工具的快速访问。您可以切换设置(例如,夹点、捕捉、极轴追踪和对象捕捉)。您也可以通过单击某些工具的下拉箭头,来访问它们的其他设置。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"UWyYdYMswoO4c8xYLQoc0c0NnMf"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1576,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"关于【状态栏】","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/0289ad8b0a9346f0bffb91efafd6a3d8","width":2330},"text":"","id":"Gc00d4A4goYygoxOK0fc0Tqfnjb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"注:默认情况下,不会显示所有工具,您可以通过状态栏上最右侧的按钮,选择您要从“自定义”菜单显示的工具。状态栏上显示的工具可能会发生变化,具体取决于当前的工作空间以及当前显示的是“模型”选项卡还是布局选项卡。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Py4idgqqSoWYcKxGQBPcQmPlnvg"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":64,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"关于【状态栏】","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/ee8c5ee7e72a40cda78f0e4ba3e571ca","width":527},"text":"","id":"BWeedcOo4o8GyWxM1HocnYQGnzf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"您还可以使用键盘上的功能键(F1–F12),切换其中某些设置。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"RCa2dKgysoewmIx4ELocRXssnnc"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1024,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"关于【状态栏】","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/3487e9ca8fdd40acaeb08bd4a173ab8f","width":642},"text":"","id":"TwUEdo2mMomWmcxtFSPcyKZ9ndy"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"关于【快捷菜单】","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Z6KsdIuwYoaQ4kxyAH7cd3vqnNg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"名词解释:显示快速获取当前动作有关命令的快捷菜单。在屏幕的不同区域内单击鼠标右键时,可以显示快捷菜单。快捷菜单上通常包含以下选项:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"GqA8dQCwSomimaxaQ5mcnOOXnJf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"1、重复执行输入的上一个命令;","id":""}],"text":"","id":"SWQudeYOUoYqgkxop4CcBkYCnSg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"2、取消当前命令;","id":""}],"text":"","id":"TsUEdaaE0oygGexwZsHcNZMmnRc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"3、显示用户最近输入的命令的列表;","id":""}],"text":"","id":"AsQydI0uEoKMC4xkDB0cKWq5nac"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"4、剪切、复制以及从剪贴板粘贴;","id":""}],"text":"","id":"MUG6dIIycouqkgx02O5c4syenWf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"5、选择其他命令选项;","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Mi6udwqwQoyCKyx4DQfcDkEMnwg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"6、显示对话框,例如“选项”或“自定义”;","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Cgiyd0ikKooqY8x02gic4cY6n6g"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"7、放弃输入的上一个命令;","id":""}],"text":"","id":"IUkqdWaemo6AyuxIXsschJoYnCd"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"显示快捷菜单的步骤","id":""}],"text":"","id":"MiiMdGSqsoUwK8xRM2ocXbi2nj1"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在图形中的对象或区域、菜单中的按钮或功能区中单击鼠标右键。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"HYk0d0GsEoeqMkxmWNgcjUrdn9c"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":683,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"显示快捷菜单的步骤","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/6a245cbbe343499997f212ccac5737e8","width":898},"text":"","id":"YEGYdIoE4og6koxcTY5cUZWMnGb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在绘图区域,单击鼠标右键","id":""}],"text":"","id":"DoagdKMwgouGYOxwxjbcj8n2nyb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在某些定点设备上,可能需要按住相应的按钮。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"注:显示与光标位置相关的快捷菜单。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"FmiedOmqMo0koqx6TgSc3EKcn1b"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":1},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"学习步骤","id":""}],"text":"","id":"USkSdy8aOoSkuOxId4ZcHRiOnqb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"学习CAD制图,我们从浅入深可分3个阶段进行。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"YC6udAaGcoqGYSxqsNqcFHQunxe"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"掌握基础操作","id":""}],"text":"","id":"PEQ6dgAsco2qy4xkfa2cT62gn3c"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"熟悉CAD的绘图命令、掌握CAD软件操作逻辑。这就像我们学认字、写字一样,先掌握基础的笔画、笔顺开始。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Nq00dEi2EoCqSwxfHutco5aJnr5"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":3},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"制图常用的基本命令1","id":""}],"text":"","id":"VoGCdMYmooyCOsxExIgc4h0InDb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"CAD绘图命令:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"MqIOdAq0koEuYExkFPGc670nnjg"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":536,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"制图常用的基本命令1","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/5cb73fb2ab844ebc8dcecc74e9b1c0b2","width":408},"text":"","id":"WKUAdiU22oAi6exCDCechXHZncb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"CAD修改命令:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"ZCsydmM6eoaGGixW4XCcswetnZb"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":471,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"制图常用的基本命令1","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/5133f6f73d2e400cbf69965348233dfa","width":407},"text":"","id":"IkYGdIsoQo2EagxaiYXcdyAxnGd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"CAD尺寸标注命令:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Dio2daOI4ocaiwxY5WictEUCnIh"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":426,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"制图常用的基本命令1","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/9fc50792cb2746ba963fe47fb513c39b","width":408},"text":"","id":"TW6GdsiwiowM8MxgtuKcQwzbntg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"视窗缩放:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"GcegdcWsWowkKExw9HoccxfHnpe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"对象特性:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"FMoIdsOMIoK0kQxaif2cIOLfnFc"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":681,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"制图常用的基本命令1","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/b7476812bc554eb9895607f9fb2532db","width":640},"text":"","id":"PE8EdcaY2oyM2UxuUeYcawxRnIb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"常用CTRL快捷键:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"AAImdSQSUoqwI2xIh8Tc45PNnRb"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":498,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"制图常用的基本命令1","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/cc9067fb35084d92ae3403cd8beba3c2","width":640},"text":"","id":"Ucm4dY8IQoimASxqNBHcNQiMnZQ"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"常用功能键:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"WMQsdooewo2QimxKou4c9z6Fnfd"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":544,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"制图常用的基本命令1","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/175719c5515a46219877cede90eb1e89","width":500},"text":"","id":"F4qYdiw4soA4EyxkpNBcQgT8nYc"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":3},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"制图常用的基本命令2","id":""}],"text":"","id":"FsIsdmi8KoeIe6x6g6lcUhRonLg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"1、绘图栏上数下第一命令是——直线,快捷键L,不分大小写。直线命令是我们最常用的命令,也是绘图的基础中的基础。若要绘制直线,请单击“直线”工具;","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Neicd4WqmoogKoxuWXxcGFKqnig"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":135,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"制图常用的基本命令2","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/a267c91708df430f946687498e777c89","width":216},"text":"","id":"G2QCdmcQ2oaQm8xIzQncjFlEnod"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在绘图区域用鼠标左键单击一次,其目的是为了指定直线线段的第一个起点;松开鼠标,往任意方向拖动,线段会跟着拖动幅度变长变短;","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Vy86dya2eoQCe6xKuiIcnfUQnXb"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":282,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"制图常用的基本命令2","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/b638ec57cac44f3da374391ee21a23cd","width":470},"text":"","id":"IUo6dw6KuoGAcixuAcMclNS7n0e"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"这时,我们会看见直线的旁边有一个白色的输入框,里面的数值会随着我们的拖动幅度而变化,这里面的数值代表是直线的长度,我们可以在里面输入任意数值确定直线长度,然后按Enter或者空格键完成一条直线的绘制。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"MWUUdSgaMoOgIcxWADOcPdzAnEh"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":282,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"制图常用的基本命令2","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/ae5a165d7654442caaa0baa9cc05fa29","width":470},"text":"","id":"Ki4idqQwkogOCuxc39mcAePCnef"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"","id":""}],"text":"","id":"A0kSdkgsgo4Mo2xo53ccxN9enUe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"2、第二个命令是——构造线。快捷键XL,它是为下一步的复制,镜象等作为基准的直线,虚线不属于图的轮廓线,一般是作为图形某一点为中心的轴线。若要绘制构造线,方法如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"TG4gdUoqyoO2S6xaBDcczlbwnHH"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在绘图工具中点击构造线工具。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"V0eSdIkUAo8WgUxmk2Cc2LjJnHg"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":562,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"制图常用的基本命令2","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/b0056b89371043d1b7080b724edb6c5c","width":1000},"text":"","id":"G0G6dKOKqogCUMxik8ecV4xUnnc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"依次在绘图板中点击一下鼠标可见构造线。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"EQU2dsIoyokcsuxCiXFcTNcCnme"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":562,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"制图常用的基本命令2","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/201a1008dc8b4183b42cc2d85a2e4f48","width":1000},"text":"","id":"OGy6dcAMAokMcsx4MNWcQY1wnTb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"3、第三个命令是——多段线。快捷键PL,它由多条线段(可以是直线,也可以是弧线)组成一个整体的线段。如想选中该线段中的一部分,必须先将其分解。平常作图经常用到,就连做地形图时也需要它,所以是很重要的命令。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Mq6wdQmEooWkUkxAfLUcz3e6nFb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"要绘制多段线,输入多段线命令敲击多段线命令PL,敲击空格键。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"FYIMdIkWKo8GeWxBZBVcZr0Bnrq"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":852,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"制图常用的基本命令2","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/44b339acf2ff47ef85fc62e8b302c8c5","width":1024},"text":"","id":"SQAIdEguCoqqEMxWsDUcyB9vn2d"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"绘制多段线在CAD绘图区指定直线的起点,输入多段线的长度,敲击空格键即可。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"WCWcdU4qmoKkUwxsbE8cMB8Ln2c"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":937,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"制图常用的基本命令2","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/d467194c158045e09842f6d3ea0bedc2","width":1024},"text":"","id":"Q8g8dY6KCoGqAExA5I0cCpPOnqd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"","id":""}],"text":"","id":"EmAwdauc2owkY2xOYy7clUFVnhb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"4、第四个命令是——正多边形。快捷键POL,顾名思义是可以绘制多边形,点击命令,输入边的数量,然后选择内切圆或者外切圆,就可以绘制了。绘制步骤如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Ng2qd6Wa4os6SSxsfeKcuhjwnyd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"1/5要绘制正多边形,需要输入命令:“POL”-“空格”,也可以在顶部的选项卡中找相应的按钮点击,但是有点麻烦。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"PsCCdEy4EoYSquxWwtwchUQonJg"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":650,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"制图常用的基本命令2","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/97dc5459d7844ac39d841829e5572df0","width":1062},"text":"","id":"CYUyd4YoooQ6uIxoKztckifSn2B"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"2/5命令行这个时候会提醒你:输入侧面数。这个侧面数的意思,就是多边形的边数,几个侧面,就是几边形。这里输入6。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"TSSOdGU8oocQGUxualSctpL5nHg"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":650,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"制图常用的基本命令2","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/eb86e6fb721c427f95ac05c41d24324e","width":1062},"text":"","id":"WeuOdMA0qowi4yxa4jlcLB28nWu"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"3/5接下来就是按照提示:指定多边形的中心,这个应该好理解,可以通过鼠标点选,或者键盘输入坐标的方式来指定中心。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"JwYqdegK8owoiExrxbDch483nMo"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":650,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"制图常用的基本命令2","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/8094966debf84a11b7b6053d5456ced7","width":1062},"text":"","id":"NGi6dEUKWoiIa4xQBX7cyuMPn2g"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"","id":""}],"text":"","id":"UGKsdaIkMo0ouMxGArIcdpSRn7c"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"4/5命令行提示:内接于圆,或者外切于圆。因为AutoCAD表征多变形的特征是通过内接圆/外切圆的直径来的,所以这里要指明。我们选外切圆。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"CqcwdYam8oSi2Ixy0SmcbBk3n0b"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":650,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"制图常用的基本命令2","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/267d4582a7c046a8ae60e8ca6a88ed39","width":1062},"text":"","id":"BuOadUsg0o624CxeYWYcqWujnRe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"5/5这个时候,就需要指定外切圆的直径了,我们通过鼠标点选的方式来完成指定,就可以绘出正六边形了。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"FkOMdSWs6oOCeAx6nURcHJJ7nhe"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":650,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"制图常用的基本命令2","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/9790aea05b584988ad355a2cb1633ca4","width":1062},"text":"","id":"B0YGdi886oucOuxsHD3cyiu9n8b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"5、第五个命令是——矩形。快捷键REC,可以快速绘制出矩形宽,这个也是很常用的一个命令。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"SKASdkaoAoaoeKxYrALcc3gGnpe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在功能区单击矩形按钮,然后再绘图区域任意处点击,确定矩形的一个角点,然后拖动鼠标,在任意处点击,确定第二个角点位置,这时矩形就绘制完成了。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"NQAmdi00IoQMkaxEl6YcGZsRnlb"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":591,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"制图常用的基本命令2","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/381600818dea4003a774e31a93032b3c","width":853},"text":"","id":"VssIdkuEmogw24x8HxncNQ4vn5d"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"","id":""}],"text":"","id":"D2w6ds4KyoIG2ex2Fxmc3HJWnYb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"6、第六个命令是——圆弧。快捷键ARC,绘制圆弧命令可以快速画出弧线,示意门之类的地方很常用。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"R4QGdmGCao6cCCxk3TWckXFYnTg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"首先打开软件,然后在命令行输入快捷键命令:ARC,按回车键确认,根据命令行提示在绘图区域指定圆弧的起点或 [圆心(C)],接着继续指定圆弧的第二个点或[圆心(C)/端点(E)],即可完成圆弧的绘制了。如下图所示:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"DqG2dgEAgoaYw0xrBgTcuv3cnt8"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":641,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"制图常用的基本命令2","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/d28443b65638464e80947ed86561d100","width":1024},"text":"","id":"JSoWducuIoGuoSxm4twc0JD9nXc"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":3},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"背诵秘籍口诀","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Dk8GdSKC0o6Woux0expcQbxKnwg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"1、想到直线就用L+空格","id":""}],"text":"","id":"T2asdCqQOoimuyxYPgJcFkdenah"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"2、想到圆就用C+空格","id":""}],"text":"","id":"TsEodQ6AWoe04MxkzA2cYMjmnBd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"3、想到圆弧就用A+空格","id":""}],"text":"","id":"ZqIcdUAMaoiSUcx2uxRcX6l8nUt"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"4、想到矩形就用REC+空格","id":""}],"text":"","id":"OiMwd4IAIomMeYxsjqzcYTyOnxc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"5、想到点就用PO+空格","id":""}],"text":"","id":"CYEadUmgIoWucmxAV7bcsWr8nDg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"6、想到单行文本就用DT","id":""}],"text":"","id":"J6OwdMqWsoIcIexyiSHcdD2hnYe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"7、想到多行文本就用MT","id":""}],"text":"","id":"G4UMdsog0oU6S2xuuQjcF4lIn5b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"8、想到填充就用H","id":""}],"text":"","id":"VuMidCigCoUUGCxUMducczA7nhb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"9、想到线段延伸到某一线段就用EX+空格","id":""}],"text":"","id":"X2IOdMYYyouGYMxWeavcJUwsnqh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"10、想到矩形倒圆角就用F+空格","id":""}],"text":"","id":"IGgidgaycoOAsSxA108cPJjtnah"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"11、想到修剪绘图过程中多余的线就用TR+空格","id":""}],"text":"","id":"GEaEdCKAwoScMixu41HcPAVWnOh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"12、想到修改文本就用ED+空格","id":""}],"text":"","id":"BYqQdIKaGo6WSPxxJoqc0onHnE8"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"13、想到移动就用M+空格;","id":""}],"text":"","id":"VKYgdkQqWoowwGxIrO8cBf6znhf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"14、想到旋转就用RO+空格","id":""}],"text":"","id":"GSCMdu4eeow2AQxM1prcQXoinOg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"15、想到偏移就用O+空格","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Uu80dKCEgoYggYxodqPc8CvgnIh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"16、想到镜像就用MI+空格","id":""}],"text":"","id":"UIYcdGWiso0YAEx2d6jcWtlWn0f"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"17、想到复制就用CO+空格","id":""}],"text":"","id":"WKWed2E4yoogIixWQdFcBxHMnVh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"18、想到局部观察平面图细节就用Z+空格","id":""}],"text":"","id":"N0oSdEgCioQKAAxUJujc8afknQh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"19、想到实时缩放放大镜就用Z+空格+空格","id":""}],"text":"","id":"ZEg2dys4So2QECxIqtccBtB1nyF"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"20、想到平移视图就用P+空格","id":""}],"text":"","id":"GaSedyquWoq8A4xasfWcXFE8nud"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"21、想到平移视图平移视图就用P+空格","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Ous8dwEGeomcosxkN9Kc6edEnyh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"22、想到返回上一视图就用Z+空格+P+空格","id":""}],"text":"","id":"ViKudCo4aoWAUIxUfXxcSuidnze"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"23、想到全局显示自己绘的平面图就用Z+空格+A+空格","id":""}],"text":"","id":"VScGdgueeowU6cxOYBCcfU1HnGc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"24、想到打印文件就用CTRL+P","id":""}],"text":"","id":"I20QdAe4MoM482xRIbEcvAyung5"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"25、想到复制,就用CTRL+C","id":""}],"text":"","id":"BWuEdc0cyoGOuaxQHmDcTMORnSd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"26、想到粘贴就用CTRL+V","id":""}],"text":"","id":"LKIOdWM4QoqWySxicj6c4Ounnfc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"27、想到剪切就用,CTRL+X代表","id":""}],"text":"","id":"XYK6duIMeoOKsWxQTgYcuIAwnEe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"28、想到新建文件就用CTRL+N","id":""}],"text":"","id":"RGcqdOU0EoqEqux8bjNc8XUonpe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"29、想到寻求帮助时,就用F1","id":""}],"text":"","id":"BiEWdqg2youUemxSCNNcPPGynte"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"30、想到正交就用F8","id":""}],"text":"","id":"J6wEd4wUKoyQMixGOzoco5dIntb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"31、想到打开和关闭对象捕捉工具就用F3","id":""}],"text":"","id":"PYSsdeiI8o40e6xcTl5cJAAmnpc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"32、想到直线标注就用DLI+空格","id":""}],"text":"","id":"M0k8dqyWcoo0sAxZl0Kcg5HmnH2"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"33、想到调整文字样式就用ST+空格","id":""}],"text":"","id":"EgCYdKOkiomagqxodUDcBQSunme"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"34、想到重新生成就用R+E+空格","id":""}],"text":"","id":"MwmudIyGqoImWKxUNCmcyPNJnSh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"35、想要设置捕捉模式就用OS+空格","id":""}],"text":"","id":"UkUadm6oAo4ie2xSgJ6cGwZWnup"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"36、想到重复上一次的操作就用ENTER","id":""}],"text":"","id":"LsKwdaO6GoCSgExuo0JciafCnWc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"37、想到刷新就用RE+空格","id":""}],"text":"","id":"LCOcdGOCaowawUxM3o7cUgu1nNb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"38、想到取消正在执行的可用ESC","id":""}],"text":"","id":"NeA0doguwoEYuexeNJmcoaWMnVy"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"39、想到设置捕捉模式就用OS","id":""}],"text":"","id":"XAWgd2iOioYq2axO2J7cDgZdnsp"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"40、想到旋转就用RO","id":""}],"text":"","id":"SCQcdwy8wouEyixuCs6c9FgQnEq"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"41、想到计算面积就用AA","id":""}],"text":"","id":"OEkIdQMYCo2yeMx6i9QcY0N1n4g"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"42、想到平移就用P+空格","id":""}],"text":"","id":"CQimdiemsoqOQ6xw2hrc8DEMntU"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"43、想到最常用的标注快就用DLI","id":""}],"text":"","id":"F4ysdiK0yoywKMx7eeocBy19nt9"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"44、想到直线就用LINE","id":""}],"text":"","id":"OuGOdaaWIoocamxuospcQn0RnKd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"45、想到圆就用C","id":""}],"text":"","id":"V8Aud8iSioKogCx4Z9LcTHg0nZp"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"46、想到偏移就用O","id":""}],"text":"","id":"NawudCkW2oaOGUxya4mcqTiInje"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"47、想到修改文本就用ed","id":""}],"text":"","id":"SuOAdQwAIoaQSkxoNj8coIRgnAb"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":3},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"text":"","id":"XGGUdO2wooGO0KxuGpKcWrkxnPc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"一、选择逻辑","id":""}],"text":"","id":"KyAGdc0yKoYgyixaKYPc3trWnTe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"如图,这里我绘制了一些直线、圆、矩形。单击其中的一个圆与一条直线,它们变成了被选中的状态。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"XMSCdQGSwoEqscxGuepcFpmQnKb"},{"type":"imageList","children":[{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":751,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/4fb7b3c5b93f488fbd3127d551e57ccc","width":1024},"text":"","id":"QgwYdyUQeo2A8cxjeSicBJg0nGn"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":748,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/a517df5234f14a9d8eef9130e396fd55","width":1024},"text":"","id":"Cmyodewg2o6ewSx6G5FcN2uBnpf"}],"text":"","id":"Ei2GdqouAosKKux662kccX3Snvh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"但是如果元素特别多,那一个一个单击显然不现实,如下图请你一个个单击给我看。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Ei2GdqouAosKKux662kccX3Snvh"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":683,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/42a0bd50a29a4d1e8ee18bebbf1670bd","width":1024},"text":"","id":"P2kgdWGW2oOcCKxaCWVcuKCLnMg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"这时候就要用到框选了。在CAD中,框选有两种形式,这里以下面的图为例来解释。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"XGwWdSeomoiemOxHAIQcJhvknvj"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":480,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/ccb6ee5bb77046d39eef2a9f29f3a746","width":1024},"text":"","id":"LuoedMAskom82kxSqjFcHFTingf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"1是从左往右按住鼠标左键框选,此时选框呈蓝色,这种形式下只有框选的图形完全被框住才能被选中。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"FKOudCaEMom2kQxAOx4cbUJGncb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"如图,我完全框住了前三条直线,但第四条没完全框住,此时被选中的只有前三条线。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"X80gd8EqMoeOQSxq4GpcXzNXn8c"},{"type":"imageList","children":[{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":553,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/e310ae3da9644783a361690a1e9fa4fd","width":1024},"text":"","id":"PIwadSUMcoyCYqx6Z5CcfB21nKb"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":486,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/ebe757b1326d4a1b93432c2d86079b8c","width":1024},"text":"","id":"Uuw6d0eIuo00Qex2TTQcqgkCnRd"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":486,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/ebe757b1326d4a1b93432c2d86079b8c","width":1024},"text":"","id":"Uuw6d0eIuo00Qex2TTQcqgkCnRd"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":461,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/80e9c609cca04e69b1b8f1aa3e7a0b11","width":720},"text":"","id":"DyEUdgAqaomUqMxKyUBcsW0gnOW"}],"text":"","id":"ZySGdakucoe0aAxQd36cAz3HnZc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"2是从右往左按住鼠标左键框选,此时选框呈绿色,这种形式下只要接触到被框选的图形,它就会被选中。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"ZySGdakucoe0aAxQd36cAz3HnZc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"同样的,我们从右往左框住前三条线,第四条线只框一半如图,此时即使第四条线没框全,但选框接触到它也能被选中了。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"RaW4dIw2yoAqw0xAJ1FcvBeanqh"},{"type":"imageList","children":[{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":504,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/de0e63cfcf264058bc890fe5b1d873ad","width":1024},"text":"","id":"D42IdU2o0oc62qxemvdcIWnpnce"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":468,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/46ca082556724c8c8523422230dbe5f0","width":1024},"text":"","id":"LiEudYiqMoGEkux4bjsc6POdnrb"}],"text":"","id":"E460deiYkoMaGCxwrrtclePTnZb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"这里插一点,如果你框选以后想取消选择,只需按ESC即可。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"E460deiYkoMaGCxwrrtclePTnZb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"如果你只想取消部分图形的选中状态,只需按住shift再将你想取消选择的图形进行框选(逻辑同样是上面两种形式),此时被框中的图形就会取消被选中的状态。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"LCkMdWuugoAYCGxWEjZcBZtInwb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"这样的两种框选模式看似简单,但学会实际运用它们是能大大提高你的画图效率的。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"OyeEdWSmco2GauxSNBgcRYANnzH"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"下面我举个简单的例子,如图,一个矩形中有许多交叉的直线。如果我只想选中直线的部分,而不想选中矩形怎么办?这里提供两种思路。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"MQ6CdQukkoSu6yxKUijcX18Mnrh"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":536,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/55837732dd82475689f197f0d96f9154","width":1024},"text":"","id":"T8oOdQmmGowaCmxaB34cSymrnpH"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"1、在矩形内部,从右往左进行框选使选框接触到所有直线,这样即使直线外部未被框柱,所有直线还是会被选中","id":""}],"text":"","id":"EgsAdK4mwoMAKQx2jtkcpf6JnOh"},{"type":"imageList","children":[{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":490,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/7ec34ea64e85482da4bcdc2cd0aa5265","width":1024},"text":"","id":"NEQadaaoQog0QSxgzJBcvoeUnKb"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":556,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/484cc15f700a48fe89448a953ad7c3a6","width":1024},"text":"","id":"KYgYd048Ko6a4OxlblGcwaG4nFN"}],"text":"","id":"RGgKdCs4moK6YaxwR0mcXotUnog"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"2、先从左往右把所有元素选中,再按住shift从右往左框选,只接触到外部矩形的部分,将它取消选中状态。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"RGgKdCs4moK6YaxwR0mcXotUnog"},{"type":"imageList","children":[{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":588,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/ab022f81dcc945e598d74e5316b6d993","width":1024},"text":"","id":"Rq8Cd24gUo2oAix67LucVXNFn1e"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":547,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/7d28583f1b83479e8f3f29e8f10715fc","width":1024},"text":"","id":"PmeIdyuOQoaeGoxmwOvcHS2bnIc"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":547,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/7d28583f1b83479e8f3f29e8f10715fc","width":1024},"text":"","id":"PmeIdyuOQoaeGoxmwOvcHS2bnIc"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":556,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/34c9d1bc9a394e97b79fcf03e55972dd","width":1024},"text":"","id":"TOCkdg48io8cOEx2rLnc3w5HnTh"}],"text":"","id":"FEWCd4egsoS0C8xWQ3hcG96Yn6e"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"二、键盘命令","id":""}],"text":"","id":"FEWCd4egsoS0C8xWQ3hcG96Yn6e"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"取消、删除、撤销、重做。任何绘图软件都离不开以上四种操作,这里我将CAD这四种操作的快捷键告诉大家。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"CekcdS8cWosm68xenN9c6vlZnWk"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"取消:ESC","id":""}],"text":"","id":"AKSqd4gSKoYQwwxyiiFca81fn6g"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"删除:Delete","id":""}],"text":"","id":"AGmydmgqGoigKsxmq9jcFDxpnNb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"撤销:Ctrl+Z(撤销多步就多按几次)","id":""}],"text":"","id":"VwOgdq8U6owAqQxJLcqc7tPSndd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"重做:Ctrl+Y(重做一般与撤销搭配使用,如果你撤销多了一步,按重做会回到上一步)","id":""}],"text":"","id":"C8sGd6w2soW6iExA9uSc4nLGnVd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"三、鼠标中键","id":""}],"text":"","id":"D0qWd8GC4ogUgGxU15fct1REnEe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"1、双击鼠标中键:显示全部图形对象。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"B4uYdymeaoAmKoxaIxUcyQEAn3e"},{"type":"imageList","children":[{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":457,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/fca57e97ffef49f0bf63665bf77a0c16","width":1080},"text":"","id":"Sua0dckEko0W8Uxo34ZcjCn0nDe"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":425,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/ef8ad7f3c0c9413d86f2fd65b8bfa1b7","width":720},"text":"","id":"AAsIdc8SEoKMW6xQvaecAC8Nnvf"}],"text":"","id":"A4AsdYkeUo8GsCxKkAZcfNiintf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"","id":""}],"text":"","id":"A4AsdYkeUo8GsCxKkAZcfNiintf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"2、按住鼠标中键拖动鼠标:移动图纸","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Ce4IdOSuWomSwCxYJPGcYfcRnTf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"此时十字光标会变成一只小手,你可以通过拖动鼠标来移动图纸。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"XyCcd2wQYoucQOxaEV8c1D5XnOh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"3、滚动鼠标中键:缩放图纸。这个大家应该都懂,缩放图纸与上面的拖动图纸配合使用,方便你找到图形的位置。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"JM0wdiSy4oYO6cxM70CcCOQ7nOe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"4、命令栏","id":""}],"text":"","id":"O8QOdKsSKoUO82xUzgXc9vqznvb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"CAD这个软件,在我看来最重要的就是它的命令栏。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"IO2Sdauw6oQ0YmxwUPbctbnenP1"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"几乎你画在图上的一切东西都与它有关。首先它的位置在之前讲过,位于CAD界面的下方,共两栏。上面一栏表示已结束的命令,下面一栏表示现在的命令。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"IMEQdaEimoIImaxUz3Lclj4Jned"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":34,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/b5599979f7134709bd64cd0ecbcf4236","width":1080},"text":"","id":"MooGdUIqyo2QUGxoFBpc5sHDneN"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"CAD的命令栏,就相当于一个你的助手,它会指引你做每一步操作。下面举个简单的例子。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Dyq2dM6KkoeEk2xGIZmcFMipnCe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"如下图,首先我们选择CAD左侧绘图工具中的直线。(可直接键盘上输入L再按空格/回车)此时命令栏第二行提示指定第一个点。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"IgocdOce4o8coUxKU8cc1g7HnWd"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":198,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/54539c27a4d3464f990d7fec38c39246","width":34},"text":"","id":"GmGadmkkwoiKEQxaJHNc3uWgnEi"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"我们在绘图区空白处单击一下,此时命令显示为指定下一点或放弃U。(由于这条线还没画完,此时第一栏并没有内容,即没有上一步命令)此时你再选绘图区另外一点,一条直线就画完了;如果你输入U,则放弃绘制这条直线。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"JSQKdQACCoeU0GxX40ycuRpKnvx"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":33,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/e4b1c0f037384738aac9071febec4b6e","width":241},"text":"","id":"SOi6dqy8yokQq8xUhUbc90knnTf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"而此时命令栏还是提示指定下一点或放弃。这里你有两种选择。1是单击空格/回车键,则线段绘制完毕。2是继续选择另一点,那么就会出现两条线。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Qs44d6IY4oIe6gxCcgscWM2xnKg"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":625,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/5a8da029d832434e866cb5f1d4fff303","width":1024},"text":"","id":"M6mgdMGOMoC2eKx5PR4cIk9wnBL"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"此时命令栏的提示多了一项:闭合C。如果你键盘输入C,则两条线段头尾相接,不在一条直线上则形成三角形。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"AIkSdWUoOok6SUxU3e4cS1wtnFf"},{"type":"imageList","children":[{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":30,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/8ceae07a20f042cfaa3ab14d177652e8","width":348},"text":"","id":"LEGSdUOsUo8C80xOO79cwpoNnrc"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":469,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/81e7edd7427d4bcc8a660a69ae20d4c5","width":720},"text":"","id":"PQ4AdcqmmoqSmQxqSMNcax2Kn1e"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":469,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/81e7edd7427d4bcc8a660a69ae20d4c5","width":720},"text":"","id":"PQ4AdcqmmoqSmQxqSMNcax2Kn1e"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":31,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/a45bd78cf7014e39a362f8421cf2777d","width":416},"text":"","id":"SUUqdoG2coiGKYxMdo0cOoobnXe"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":31,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/a45bd78cf7014e39a362f8421cf2777d","width":416},"text":"","id":"SUUqdoG2coiGKYxMdo0cOoobnXe"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":459,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/6deef09719b243929584555f7946a5f0","width":1024},"text":"","id":"RsOudaYyOosuCuxAtv0ci7jLnve"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":459,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/6deef09719b243929584555f7946a5f0","width":1024},"text":"","id":"RsOudaYyOosuCuxAtv0ci7jLnve"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":430,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/fe87fed395514abdb941d3246f04b4ee","width":1024},"text":"","id":"Wo8OdwG84og0YixAh11ctTesnQe"}],"text":"","id":"AicSd0eK4oMwSOxeqFvc4lVWn2d"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"这里注意两点:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"AicSd0eK4oMwSOxeqFvc4lVWn2d"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"绘制完图形对象后,再单击空格或回车键,即可结束整个命令。如果你想重复上一次的命令,比如想继续画线段,只需再按下空格,会自动重复上一次指令。此时又要开始选择线段的第一个点……","id":""}],"text":"","id":"DUKudMOiqo6Ug6xayHfcHMVtnyb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"以上牵扯到一个核心的操作逻辑。即CAD的命令栏在你选择完基础命令后一步步指引你进行操作,给你提供多种选择。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"L8qcdC0MkokOi8xyIzfcvyaGnfd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"即使你对这个命令不熟悉,通过命令栏的提示你也能很快理解。例如刚才举的例子画线段,我们都知道两点确定一线段,因此CAD中绘制线段在命令栏中分两步,分别是确定两个点的位置。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"HcSyd2IcMooE4UxG2j8c4WRXnjb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"5、状态栏","id":""}],"text":"","id":"UmSmdsKWqo6KeixQ9mOc096xnoh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"状态栏位于命令栏下方。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Qe6Qd8QwqoMsMWxEti9cZsZjn8g"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"前半部分有一个坐标点的数据,它表示的是十字光标在绘图区的位置,而它的参照物是CAD绘图区的坐标原点,如下图。这里需要注意的是,Z轴的数字一般是0,因为我们主要是绘制平面上的图形。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"GIgKdu4kcowKSaxmyLccgQqxnPf"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":20,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/7d3985e450e540358e0427eba7581ad5","width":628},"text":"","id":"Sgm0dig2eo4yuYxiqyHcqkPgnYg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"状态栏重点在于后半部分的几个按钮,掌握它们,你的绘图效率会得到极大的提高。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"TsAydq2a0oQCGSx4EJ0ctqfen4c"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":625,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/6ff68b9a3bea4f9dace01c4d8a42f4d8","width":1024},"text":"","id":"ZCG0d8OGcouWoyxoBZjcVoXdnGA"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"1、首先说下捕捉模式和栅格显示","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Zk0mdokiUoYGk4xO0z9cg2mFnvb"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":23,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/b24440318dc049968eb6991a0664a1de","width":49},"text":"","id":"YSeadmuOooYMKUxMPvdc8nOnn7f"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"它们一般搭配使用,捕捉会自动捕捉最近的栅格点,栅格则是体现在绘图区会出现栅格网,这两个按钮我建议大家关掉,会对绘图的视线造成干扰,同时容易使光标闪烁。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Uq4idIkkWoYEYaxk1qicOtwFn9e"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"2、接下来是正交模式","id":""}],"text":"","id":"V40cdWCeMoAK4IxG4ITc6Y4snYb"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":27,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/605790387b9d4b4d99444e6cedf47a4a","width":26},"text":"","id":"MCE6d4cWmoUw46xqKYWctktMnuh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"开启和关闭它的快捷键是键盘上的F8,经常会用到希望大家记住。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"ReYmdSywYo6ciWxsniwczX2Wnvc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"这个模式非常重要。如果你要画直线,希望直线横平竖直,即只在XY方向绘制,那么打开正交模式,所有画出来的线条都会在XY方向。与此相关的是其后的极轴模式。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"IAcSdcAK2oOgUOxT6nrc5XTVnwp"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":26,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/1954273a2fb4431aa4730bec80dcec8b","width":26},"text":"","id":"UUM4dY8weoQ8UwxWij9ch9hQnqb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"就是通常的带角度的绘图模式,与正交模式相反。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"SkKIduqm2og6maxwfN7c3O8dnKh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"3、对象捕捉,快捷键F3","id":""}],"text":"","id":"FgiId0ekCokOq4x4gozcQpRjnKb"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":29,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/443f2a6e37c8426c86f9e0f55abb70d3","width":32},"text":"","id":"SYsUdeMkuoCgQuxyIZTcN1VMnOd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"这个模式可以极大极大极大极大提高绘图的效率,非常重要!这里先举个简单的例子。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"HKGUdSa4UosGuoxy6Pkc517gn4I"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"当你绘制出了一个矩形,想选中的它的一个角点往上画别的东西,这个时候把对象捕捉模式打开,那么你会发现,当光标移动到矩形角点附近时,会在角点上出现一个绿色的小框。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Ek2cdSqYYoiSeOxeKnXcFAcmnod"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"此时如果你要再往上画个矩形,那么当你绘制时,你会发现矩形的角点自动吸附到了原矩形的角点上。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"WAC8dmCggo0m2ixwDQOck1bUnlp"},{"type":"imageList","children":[{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":696,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/8cded5b88575476f954861ceee0f5f7c","width":1024},"text":"","id":"JaqWdyAcWoC0GgxsvZwc0Z1en1b"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":783,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/26105262aeda4740b45e76e2e88cbd6f","width":1024},"text":"","id":"AWO2dEgUmosu4MxwF9Bcm0PJnA3"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":783,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/26105262aeda4740b45e76e2e88cbd6f","width":1024},"text":"","id":"AWO2dEgUmosu4MxwF9Bcm0PJnA3"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":708,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/25bca42290c44bb7949213cdade18aaf","width":1024},"text":"","id":"Gka4dwuI8oyiosxfqtHcsr6AnJF"}],"text":"","id":"DwsudKka6oAmE2xCeT8cdFZ3nEd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"因此,对象捕捉模式就像一块磁铁,它能让光标自动吸附到一些特殊的点位上,不仅仅是端点角点。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"DwsudKka6oAmE2xCeT8cdFZ3nEd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"这里鼠标右键单击对象捕捉,选择设置,里面提供了各种各样的特殊点和延长线等等。这里提醒下大家,千万别全部打开哦,不然会被各种磁铁吸来吸去,眼花缭乱反而降低效率。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"JQeadOKGComEqYx4qegcyOtwnMe"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":539,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/7e3beff9e5724db1982138d7d788e370","width":668},"text":"","id":"AseOdYGOAo4yUixQLiWc4OfGnCf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"4、对象捕捉追踪","id":""}],"text":"","id":"DqYOdg8QSoMiAuxoHzocpFVvnIh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"设想你要画两条线段,希望它们不仅平行且头尾对齐,该怎么画?","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Q2SYdWasKoAmWgxOaWBcHguqn3g"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"如下图,当你开启对象捕捉追踪后,在绘制第二条线段的第二个点时,先将光标挪到第一条线段的端点上再慢慢往下挪动(不要单击,只是挪动),此时会出现一条绿色的虚线,它就像一把尺子一样能帮助你对齐。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"McY6dUK0IoigQ4xigaWc2kM3nYb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"这时将光标慢慢往下挪,单击即可绘制出端点对齐的两条线啦。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Iqoed8kKyoWmi2xm60CctQGpnfe"},{"type":"imageList","children":[{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":695,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/ba934dc811b14b299cdf365e7cc4e1fa","width":1024},"text":"","id":"HMq4dOYOqoqsKkxYVV7ctUpYnXc"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":679,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/55616e7e00db4f6ca20e1253404426b2","width":1024},"text":"","id":"NCs0dgAsGoGmYWxsltkcgwnnn1d"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":679,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/55616e7e00db4f6ca20e1253404426b2","width":1024},"text":"","id":"NCs0dgAsGoGmYWxsltkcgwnnn1d"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":471,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基本操作逻辑","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/f1327453f80c41d88656307eb4ea6a7a","width":659},"text":"","id":"RgyMdEIo0oOssMxOcx6cWUMxn4d"}],"text":"","id":"IoqOdUKeUosg8yxEFQlcUcsznCf"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"掌握绘图基本规范","id":""}],"text":"","id":"IoqOdUKeUosg8yxEFQlcUcsznCf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"这个包括标注样式、详图、剖图、引线规范等。这就像学会了写字,组词造句一样。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"UYMgd2sASok0e8xOuEfc5Scyntg"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":3},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"基本要求","id":""}],"text":"","id":"POk2dmmYWoyUyAxk6o0ciYkVnhb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"1、所有设计室出的图纸都要配备图纸封皮、图纸说明、图纸目录。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"XWkqdu0EMoa8WwxKwfYcliPOn7b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"A、图纸封皮须注明工程名称、图纸类别(施工图、竣工图、方案图)、制图日期。 ","id":""}],"text":"","id":"CYoWdUaswo4Qgsxqd29c5Nydn3E"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"B、图纸说明须对工程进一步说明工程概况、工程名称、建设单位、施工单位、设计单位或建筑设计单位等。 ","id":""}],"text":"","id":"FAMYd0mOsocqYAxspGpcJ8DHnQb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"2、每张图纸须编制图名、图号、比例、时间。 ","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Qa22dKw00oEUu8xC0Nqch3oMnUf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"3、打印图纸按需要、比例出图。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"MgIedu6SYo8ewKxarpPcqykonfb"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":3},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"常用制图方式","id":""}],"text":"","id":"NKAidCymKougG6x8dUec7kYRnge"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"一、常用比例","id":""}],"text":"","id":"OAoQdYKusoIKqMxeWfJcTq8AnQd"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":400,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"常用制图方式","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/06b84d68c8f046d7be959ac6bfb5425b","width":560},"text":"","id":"XMo6dq4UEos4CMxKIq2cghG8nDf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"1:1、1:2、1:3、1:4、1:5、1:6、1:10","id":""}],"text":"","id":"OKksd2i4ioECyIxILgKcAMNNnSe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"1:15、1:20、1:25、1:30、1:40、1:50、1:60、1:80","id":""}],"text":"","id":"GMoWd4gSGoqOC4xsds7cUyCVn7b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"1:100、1:150、1:200、1:250、1:300、1:400、1:500","id":""}],"text":"","id":"ZcQCdgg84ociCKx0kvicwssMnzb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"二、线型","id":""}],"text":"","id":"V8GQdkmEqoyUg8xOKKsc86EinHh"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":236,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"常用制图方式","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/27ba4a03d9d54403913cf966dc9de1cc","width":414},"text":"","id":"VQimdagIwomESGx6bIicttE7ndb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"1、粗实线:0.3mm","id":""}],"text":"","id":"UcYUdE00EoMy0GxvClNcKvEXnIN"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"1)平、剖面图中被剖切的主要建筑构造的轮廓(建筑平面图)。 ","id":""}],"text":"","id":"RkQmdGWGsoASc0xU3CdcsxRJnVc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"2)室内外立面图的轮廓。 ","id":""}],"text":"","id":"TisAdkeKAoC4EUxcZtKcrRLDnLc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"3)建筑装饰构造详图的建筑物","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"表面线","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"XWsUduwgmoi6uIxQ7hocZ1wUnbe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"2、中实线:0.15-0.18mm ","id":""}],"text":"","id":"TIMmdYMqMoQSUoxcvi9cDsQ1nPh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"1)平、剖面图中被剖切的次要建筑构造的轮廓线。 ","id":""}],"text":"","id":"FySadI064oKumUxI3JVcNUD8n4b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"2)室内外平顶、立、剖面图中建筑构配件的轮廓线。 ","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Kg4UdKQUKoQECSxq88tcyld4nUg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"3)建筑装饰构造详图及构配件详图中一般轮廓线。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"AeocdK22WouAaixc7YucFvrRnm2"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"3、细实线:0.1mm","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Ueegd6iogoAGasxau0Gc0K1rnvc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"填充线、尺寸线、尺寸界限、索引符号、标高符号、分格线。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"DS6sd2uaSoQOMsxmMQrc7RCXnyh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"4、细虚线:0.1-0.13mm ","id":""}],"text":"","id":"AOmWdMEAUoegQ0xeKHLcSK0snUd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"1)室内平面、顶面图中未剖切到的主要轮廓线。 ","id":""}],"text":"","id":"A6eod4emKoYeUixqibocfn1Rngb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"2)建筑构造及建筑装饰构配件不可见的轮廓线。 ","id":""}],"text":"","id":"IywWd4UekoA0WcxmscMcgmOinKf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"3)拟扩建的建筑轮廓线。 ","id":""}],"text":"","id":"VMe4dI2E2oc6U4xiMSscOyDOnIc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"4)外开门立面图开门表示方式。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"DwSGdKKGuoqGqCxW6hBc9CEInhc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"5、细点划线:0.1-0.13mm","id":""}],"text":"","id":"CIqSdWk4Oo0MeWxsbsyceqqinXd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"中心线、对称线、定位轴线。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Ua6adeq8YocG02xofHWcj1Zxnnf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"6、细折断线:0.1-0.13mm","id":""}],"text":"","id":"VcEAdwkq2o6ak8xWqAdc8owUnGf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"不需画全的断开界线。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"DSMgdEYW8oCA4Ox4Qtnc1EZ0n8c"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"三、打印出图笔号1-10号线宽设置,选择打印,弹出的对话框的右上角有个笔形的图标,点击,出现各种颜色。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Cg4CdSIi6okuyuxuhDpcU3JPnec"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"10号特粗线","id":""},{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":":","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"1)立面地坪线2)索引剖切符号3)图标上线","id":""}],"text":"","id":"CoSIdSKqkoQqEaxCciNcwndUnVv"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"4)索引图标中表示索引图在本图的短线","id":""}],"text":"","id":"XMmWdouuQoWmsex6gM1c0PRQnVf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"四、","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"剖切索引符号","id":""}],"text":"","id":"LwSwdikmOoYCC4xpX80cYFFfnF2"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"1、m:?12mm(在A0、A1、A2、图纸)","id":""}],"text":"","id":"UOgGdSiq8o6ykwx8HtgcbwG2n4d"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"2、m:?10mm(在A3、A4图纸)","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Uskidy02Eoageux0tnFcGaMlnfb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"3、","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"特粗线","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"到索引线为剖视方向","id":""}],"text":"","id":"DWUedeSOIoY4GsxyesIcEETfnPe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"4、A:字高5mm(在A0、A1、A2、图纸),字高4mm(在A3、A4图纸)","id":""}],"text":"","id":"H4EsdUMqooSok2xaSulcMiejnCg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"5、B-01:字高3mm(在A0、A1、A2、图纸),字高2、5mm(在A3、A4图纸)","id":""}],"text":"","id":"DeaSdwK8soKcgMxecQBc05ALnBh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"6、A为索引图号,B-01为索引图纸号,B-01为“”表示索引在本图","id":""}],"text":"","id":"SYC0dk8e4oWiO2x2FXacbj3inum"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"五、平、立面索引符号","id":""}],"text":"","id":"MAo2dMQuEo4YqexmASNcJAoynpg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"1、m:?12mm(在A0、A1、A2、图纸)","id":""}],"text":"","id":"JCaoduaMmo4cGYxcXOscTM3nncg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"2、m:?10mm(在A3、A4图纸)","id":""}],"text":"","id":"KyIiduy4yoewasxKwEMcRaPjnkh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"3、A1-A4:字高4mm(在A0、A1、A2图纸),字高3mm(在A3、A4图纸)","id":""}],"text":"","id":"KaeGdaSs0oEmeixMRpxcrAqfnpY"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"4、B-01--B-04:字高2、5mm(在A0、A1、A2图纸),字高2mm(在A3、A4图纸)","id":""}],"text":"","id":"JGaCd4amEogI4sxsX4XcCDzbndd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"六、大样图索引","id":""}],"text":"","id":"MGeQd4YyeoKqMoxAZ7jcHE8LnKd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"大样引出框","id":""}],"text":"","id":"QOOOdA0SMoMogGxAXY8cdspxnvg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"1、m:?12mm(在A0、A1、A2图纸)","id":""}],"text":"","id":"QSSadCmEeok8agxIlXcciRrXnje"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"2、m:?12mm(在A3、A4图纸)","id":""}],"text":"","id":"RY2Qd8eAsos6iSxYFNAcRjrZnwf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"3、A:字高4mm(在A0、A1、A2图纸),字高3mm(在A3、A4图纸)","id":""}],"text":"","id":"QaEgdgwKMoKOM4xEvnJcfE9PnDe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"4、B-01:字高2、5mm(在A0、A1、A2图纸),字高2mm(在A3、A4图纸)","id":""}],"text":"","id":"GMGadeOMqokcmqxq6bBcQGTjnMA"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"七、图标","id":""}],"text":"","id":"V2c2dsy2CoKgK2xA1LrcGcRmnLc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"1、图名:字高7mm(在A0、A1、A2图纸),字高5mm(在A3、A4图纸)","id":""}],"text":"","id":"REYmdYMEio4YKDxTeOqcfmVHnTb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"2、比例及英文图名:字高4mm(在A0、A1、A2图纸),字高3mm(在A3、A4图纸)","id":""}],"text":"","id":"A24kdCesqoo0Ccx0W7YcvbX5ndh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"八、文字注释","id":""}],"text":"","id":"OUUGdYYGUoIC8GxCMq6cNFlunnf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"1、引出线为箭头或点,引出线为统一体,由标注命令引线制作。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"U2OudwWmioqqoOxOYFScRgnQnUf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"2、文字说明:字高4mm(在A0、A1、A2图纸),字高3mm(在A3、A4图纸)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"BCkudCUeiomUuaxyYhucppTSnrh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"九、标高符号","id":""}],"text":"","id":"DIcSdOGwuo2Qssx8lOocRtiknYd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"1、数字:字高2、5mm(在A0、A1、A2图纸),字高2mm(在A3、A4图纸)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Tg64dsQaeo2Am2xo3SLcJlrNnif"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"2、符号为等腰直角三角形。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"H0mqdi2Qeo6iI2xwJYbcFsWZnnh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"3、数字以m计单位,小数点后留三位。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"G066dEM6aoCOSQxSyDBckiYOnEd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"4、零点标高写成±0、000,正数标高不注“”,负数标高应注“-”。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"J62QdgqQKoAGskxuetXcjaxfnJg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"5、同样位置不同标高标注。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"ZY6mdGiQOogQyExGyI3cnBdCnwg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"十、轴线符号","id":""}],"text":"","id":"BsmKdQMsuoa8max0kegcEV8un4b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"1、n:?10mm,字高4mm(在A0、A1、A2图纸)","id":""}],"text":"","id":"L4uOduqsQosOkSxUNqhchCHen9d"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"2、n:?8mm,字高3.5mm(在A3、A4图纸)","id":""}],"text":"","id":"E8Iqdo2a2oOuyoxg3EZcbrf1nac"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"十一、尺寸符号","id":""}],"text":"","id":"BeAEdSOQkoqYsuxIzHVcpxcUnSb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"1、尺寸标注是尺寸为统一体,如需调整尺寸数字,可采用edit(ed)命令。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"JGIGdYc2AoAG0ixKo0PcXXMUndh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"2、尺寸界线距标注物体2-3mm,第一道尺寸线距标注物体10-12mm,相邻的尺寸线间距7-10mm。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"TyaqdIemOosQgmxYqhZchaOtnhb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"3、半径、直径标注时箭头样式为","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"实心闭合箭头","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"NmKudIWs6oUeoKxcxfbcz5hnntg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"4、标注字高2.5mm(在A0、A1、A2图纸),字高2mm(在A3、A4图纸)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"ReGUdaWGOoIsiYxuIcdcSelynfh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"5、标注文字距尺寸线1-1.5mm。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"JS4cdmuSKouquqx8y3ycQ06tngb"},{"type":"imageList","children":[{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":236,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"常用制图方式","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/f9ab7b6433b4413289112e0a21b1ca5a","width":414},"text":"","id":"Mw26dsaKwom4wIxdbwLc50kDnuR"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":412,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"常用制图方式","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/4aafd85c6f754263ad8db6912477ad1f","width":206},"text":"","id":"LmycdKeeGoqoGMxMxIUcgIAGnHg"}],"text":"","id":"GaeadOmk2okwuUxAJlxc7WAWnwb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"","id":""}],"text":"","id":"GaeadOmk2okwuUxAJlxc7WAWnwb"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":3},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"制图技巧","id":""}],"text":"","id":"CCeadcMEmoqsIAxKPTHclAQIngb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"一、图层管理","id":""}],"text":"","id":"S26WdcAcooG2qexaaiocNxAbnwf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"1、一般","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"制图分层","id":""}],"text":"","id":"KmoKdm6CsogGk4x3pXkcXb0KnIQ"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"A、墙体层(WALL);B、家具层(FURNITURE);C、填充层;D、窗层(WINDOW);E、布置层;F、","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"尺寸层","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"(DIM);G、文字层(TEXT);H、","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"轴线层","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"(DOTE);轴线标注层(AXIS);J、分格层","id":""}],"text":"","id":"YwkGdKUeAo80UuxM7aEc7V4snNg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"制图时分清各层便于调整图纸,节省时间。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Eg4OdMaSQouuUAxesY7c2QTenGg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"2、线条分色","id":""}],"text":"","id":"JgSodM2a2oGy4wxMraXcFCsqnfb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"制图时将墙体、家具、填充线、文字、分格线等线条颜色区分,便于在电脑显示时一目了然。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Io26ducEcosg6Uxor5dco138nYb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"3、图框插入","id":""}],"text":"","id":"FmmCdKWAIoske4xon9Xc2X3AnDe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"按比例插入图框","id":""}],"text":"","id":"EMOGd4KQYoGkAgxUP4RcGeoWnYx"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"首先制作1:1图框,将图框放大,与图比较看是否配合。如不配合缩放与之配合。如要作1:30的图框,第一次图框放大40后不合适,再次缩放输入3/4,即可得到1:30的图框B。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"EsmYd0400ogYOYxCsI2ctWpunBh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"二、其他","id":""}],"text":"","id":"BKm8dYAywoig8Kxo0RycO2aEnqb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"1、CAD文件在从其他文件粘贴进来后,容易出现","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"无用图层","id":""},{"type":"text","text":",可purge(pu),清理无用图层。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"C4mKdm2OQoCYMqxcfwTcAmBsnbd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"2、文字的大小是根据图纸的比例变化的,如A3图纸,比例为1:50,注释文字打印出的尺寸应该是3mm,在文字制作时,文字尺寸大小输入150。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Pwumd6gWYoiK8Ixg1Jdcm53RnNe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"3、一套图中可能会有不同的比例,在按比例插完第一个图框后,遇到不同比例的图,应根据比例的大小缩放。如有一张图比例为1:50,是正确的,现在要给另一张图插图框,假设这张图要插1:40的图框那就复制1:50的图框,然后缩放输入4/5即得。文字的大小亦可采用这种办法。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"PCqudEScSoe0AyxSU5pchx6Anwb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"4、同一个CAD界面下,如果打开多个CAD文件,可按着ctrl键点Tab键转换,浩辰CAD等可以直接在文件标签栏点文件名进行切换,最新的ACAD2014也加入了类似的功能。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"LWaqdG6cWoKycEx4oBTcXyT8nUd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"5、在多重复制同一个物体时,可将这一物体作成图块,如果修改了任意一个图块参照,则其他同名图块也随之改变,如不建立图块,则每个都需要修改。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"TOw0dOaAwoQwAWx68Pzc0S27nhg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"6、建立CAD文件时要有选择的将平面图、立面图、详图分为几个文件。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"YUu4dcaWwosYESxU5docWcESn9b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"7、最好不要将图形都花在0层上,0层主要用来定义图块。定义图块时,先将所有","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"图元","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"均设置为0层(有特殊时除外),然后再定义块,这样,在插入块时,插入时是哪个层,块就是那个层了。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Q6Mwdui2Ko4ei4xUxNGcoRR7nAb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"8、不能在DEFPOINTS层建立图元,此层默认是不打印的,在图层上的图形会打印不出来。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"AYy4dQIMUoG4SuxobhHcNMPKnwg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"9、在CAD软件的使用过程中,虽然一直说是画图,但实际上大部分都是在编辑图。因为编辑图元可以大量减少绘制图元不准确的几率,并且可以在一定程度上提高效率。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"HkskdMYK8oieWEx3yqDcncY0nHr"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"10、在使用绘图命令时,一定要设置捕捉,F3切换。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"HWMkdW82koa8cuxycF5caiG2nkf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"11、在使用绘图和编辑命令时,大部分情况下,都要采用正交模式,F8切换。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"VwgOdykCsoqag8xSImPcrG68nKf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"12、图纸大小:A0—1194*840;A1—840*597;A2—597*420;A3—420*297;A4—297*210。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Ugw6dy4yeo2weExQ5KtcoFYln5b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"13、将CAD文件转化成位图文件:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"NUqCdmsIco6w0ixCaiBcSfrAn1J"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"第一种是在CAD的菜单中,选择“输出”,再选择","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"bmp","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"的后缀存储,可以把CAD的屏幕显示内容变成","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"位图文件","id":""},{"type":"text","text":",但文件分辨率太小。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"QWSsdkWKKoGKY4xK0hpcgJfQnbe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"第二种是将CAD文件转化成为较大分辨率的位图文件。添加一个光栅图像如","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"JPG、TGA、PNG","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"等格式的","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"虚拟打印机","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"HQW2dA0MUoAuGWxGgPec6P8XnQd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"14、将EXCEL表格倒入CAD可以利用AutoXlsTable插件或是先将EXCEL表格复制,到CAD里的下拉编辑菜单的选择性粘贴即可得,到CAD后将表格炸开后即可CAD修改。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"NkgEdAogGosiEIxqymmc6LoUnzh"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"实战演练图纸设计","id":""}],"text":"","id":"I6wWdG8osoucomxSQ0UcJd9GnEe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"新手在学习CAD的时候,光掌握了CAD制图方法是不行的,还要勤于练习才行。找一些基础的练习图纸。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"OgEGdaAuYou6GoxUhivc1ccknhb"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":3},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"小白必备图纸","id":""}],"text":"","id":"QsaadsYguoyYmKxy0grcZfwqnHe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"刚开始接触到CAD的小白,肯定不能上来就直接拿一些复杂结构图纸让他们练习,做任何事都要循序渐进。下面这几张图纸涵盖了CAD机械建筑练习图,以及房屋建筑类的练习图,是CAD小白必备的练习图纸。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"HokGdcO40oA2UqxAZVjc8v6rn0d"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":330,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"小白必备图纸","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/677d8470709c43b8b999e97b7d585594","width":500},"text":"","id":"SYMEdic66occCaxKS7ycyDTingV"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"","id":""}],"text":"","id":"XyYsdcyUmoSKyIxSitDcv3NVnpe"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":330,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"小白必备图纸","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/e6ea6163c5d44a5ca2a74b97e42fdfe2","width":500},"text":"","id":"TUK4dSYKIomO0OxwnZmcRKL9nbf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"","id":""}],"text":"","id":"JQkWdICGsoMCOIxIF5BcMlyjn4f"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":330,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"小白必备图纸","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/a729d975798c4a959c4f27dff944993c","width":500},"text":"","id":"VQEcdm2mGoWg6mxAFfyclVScnwg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Jm8EdIGwGoiU6kx2GwfcKe0knab"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":330,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"小白必备图纸","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/20e5cc669b724809928588e4887e399e","width":500},"text":"","id":"J2MEdKYCEoKw4sxC6kfcycRcnjc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Y4EMdaC22oukKwxi0HJcCdacnmc"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":330,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"小白必备图纸","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/ba467375d7b541cebf4d46716e3cd9c4","width":500},"text":"","id":"AeGmdcwKcogkeixstZvc3s2InOf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"","id":""}],"text":"","id":"EmoMdMGQUo8yI8xaa44cYBwznIh"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":330,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"小白必备图纸","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/3a75711e406d4a1e96c215a3bd5103f1","width":500},"text":"","id":"JGM4dS4UAoCoYuxwZqUcNtMPnXf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"","id":""}],"text":"","id":"CQMIdIWsUoKou2xuq7ocbg9FnZf"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":330,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"小白必备图纸","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/1cff0daafc7f4e1daa2046c06f51206e","width":500},"text":"","id":"HU04daygYoSU8cx0iZIceMTHnhc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"","id":""}],"text":"","id":"POw6dS6MKoEuIqxHxBechk8knb1"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":330,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"小白必备图纸","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/7166dc8ecdf14d9d8943aae97b433a40","width":500},"text":"","id":"SCo0dmIWKosmSgxmcMYcfIrJnoh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"","id":""}],"text":"","id":"R8wod6awMoY0MsxwdOmcQ4oGnTg"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":330,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"小白必备图纸","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/4d4e9a90f4e54bc389aaac7b57b87f03","width":500},"text":"","id":"U0UsdkUImoYUAuxcWGlck7kcn7J"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":3},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"基础练习图纸","id":""}],"text":"","id":"ZggSdekOMooKaAxgfZrczDbgnlh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"基础的练习图纸,内容是由简单到复杂,由平面图形再到立体图形的绘制,可以逐步提升绘图能力,特别适合CAD初学者练习使用,下面放出部分的图纸供大家参考。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"C0MEdmSIAoaW0KxMzJ4cbiRdnGd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"","id":""}],"text":"","id":"FOmGdiIEgoCCYQxQf2IcbiE6nye"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":330,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基础练习图纸","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/0fda4f5d414e4f1bb47187e5369b9201","width":500},"text":"","id":"WWK0daACwoiMg8xkjOVco305ndf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"","id":""}],"text":"","id":"EUQQdSiwyoIk2OxQZYvcBymfn6f"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":330,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基础练习图纸","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/8e9c638bb97040e49fe83f668df540f4","width":500},"text":"","id":"FUGIdWC0Som02ox0YW8cN2ucnGf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"","id":""}],"text":"","id":"QoK8dsiqeoM2IMx2LMocOhi3nEc"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":330,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基础练习图纸","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/df7577d6f6d34d7ab04b406067e822ee","width":500},"text":"","id":"IYIUdG0cqocOUIxqWIvcK1m7nDc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"","id":""}],"text":"","id":"M20md2YsgoOssexIz2pcj17knqe"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":330,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基础练习图纸","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/b95a5ab8645b4d22b14ee46d2d9c26b1","width":500},"text":"","id":"MYe4dEU6UoOUQgxc7Tmcgfy2n1e"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"","id":""}],"text":"","id":"CuekdCYUKoI2SixGc2CcbFpDndc"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":330,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基础练习图纸","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/26a9b4981f2345d991af577efaab21d3","width":500},"text":"","id":"RMqSd2SYCosek6x4e2rc8khsngf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Cce2da8aqoWC8gx89hKcONIbnwg"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":330,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基础练习图纸","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/b8256aad01784eddb90e926a3bce6f1a","width":500},"text":"","id":"IqYidgCI2oGuC6xcH0QcotBKnNg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"","id":""}],"text":"","id":"SCkqdqycgoISY0xuwQ2coHppnkg"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":330,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基础练习图纸","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/53f0a50183274ddd9b417631b6ca4d83","width":500},"text":"","id":"AaKgdUyuWoGAwMxeajpcc1rwn4f"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"","id":""}],"text":"","id":"IA0Id8QoooYYmoxyEXsc5KbInyf"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":330,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"基础练习图纸","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/c55d395d5e4e4aa695675253f0c89335","width":500},"text":"","id":"XKQ0dwI8coAOYMxoHsicI4f7nib"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":1},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"注意事项","id":""}],"text":"","id":"YQsMdEQgIoMuUGx2156c30KwnAg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"1、学习CAD不要急于求成","id":""}],"text":"","id":"AscUd0oeMoq84ix8BeJcScKXnRf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"CAD的学习过程讲究循序渐进,先了解绘图的基本知识,打好基础,再勤加练习,知识的吸收要由浅及深,由简到繁,这样学习起来不吃力,学习的兴趣也会大一点。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"HKy8di6OmoqyGexcNZYcBBvunKd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"2、不要不遵循作图步骤","id":""}],"text":"","id":"L8GGdYeIuoAIeexczCacKkdenid"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在进行CAD绘图的时候最好首先要设置好图幅大小,然后设置单位和精度,根据绘图对象建立好图层,设置好对象样式后才开始绘图。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"HQsMdwu2YoMW6GxErtPcvOAInlf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"3、绘图比例乱设置","id":""}],"text":"","id":"ZYQGdGkc0oEGOExo1l4cAOS2nPf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在进行绘图的时候不要自己随心所欲的设置绘图比例,CAD绘图比例有很多,而每个比例都是科学设置的,最佳绘图比例是1:1,将绘图比例设置为1:1绝对不会错。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Zq4cdw6y8oaKkWxoPROcNG3WnQc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"4、不要在0层上绘图","id":""}],"text":"","id":"DECqdOsMco8YOgxQ1zWcwlVRnab"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"这一点是一定要注意的,因为0层是系统默认的图层,不能更名和删除,通常用作草稿图层或插入块,将图画在0层上容易导致图层混乱,不利于分层管理。5、不要把图框和图形画在同一副图中","id":""}],"text":"","id":"NuWydwCYMoYi66xOZRQccHINnqs"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"绘图时如果需要运用到图框应当将图框以块的形式插入进图中,而不是直接画,直接画在后面打印图纸的时候容易出现错乱。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"PW2EdyeC6oMu8oxUndXcf6g7nKc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"6、遇到问题不及时弄清楚","id":""}],"text":"","id":"E00KdioaKomkqAxIB5ccfn85nsh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在绘图时因为操作的原因可能会出现很多问题,遇到问题一定要第一时间搞清楚,因为你记着记着可能就忘了。比如说画一张图,别人画的大小适中,而你画起来图形很小,有的甚至看不见,这可能是因为你没有设置绘图界限而导致的。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"TkaIdMG2qoiYCMxCwcDcOrMenPg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"7、不设置线型比例","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Ym6ydWusio62KWxTUwSc0XUEnoV"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"没有设置线型比例可能会导致你用虚线画线但画出来看起来就像是用实线画的,线型比例在设置的时候还要根据图形的尺寸来,如果图形尺寸特别小可以将图形比例设大一点,如果图形尺寸特别大可以将图形比例设小一点。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Z04cdKCico8OmQxU0escjKYtnDr"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"8、不标注工程信息","id":""}],"text":"","id":"HSegdCAmqoWkaUxysLicn5Gbneb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"工程标注是工程的重要依据。在一幅工程图中工程标注是不可少的重要部分。在某些情况下,工程标注甚至比图形更重要。所以小伙伴们在绘图的时候一定不要忘了标注。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Cw40dk6miousE6xU8Gbc37Wvn9C"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"9、文字字体不规范","id":""}],"text":"","id":"LGyGdKWewoKYUyxknpNcIyNYnfF"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"文字是CAD图纸不可缺少的一部分,如尺寸标注文字、图纸说明等,在标注的时候很多小伙伴都会用自己喜欢的字体,这样是错误的,规范的字体是“长仿宋体”。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"VQGMdaW4qoWMA4xq8ODcFDW4nPe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"","id":""}],"text":"","id":"QKOIdouKYosKu6xga8zc1RcRnN2"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"","id":""}],"text":"","id":"EUAWdYGokoswAyxsJL4crd4Nnhf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"","id":""}],"text":"","id":"Sa4EdWCA8o0oaqxoTVscr1Uwnwh"}]%3C%2Fhowto_content%3E
- 上一篇: 我的世界蜘蛛眼有啥用(我的世界蜘蛛的眼睛有啥
- 下一篇: 我的世界生活大冒险(我的世界生活大冒险mod
相关阅读
更多资讯
- 我的世界生活大冒险(我的世界生活大冒险mod)
- 我的世界服务器地址是啥?地址是不是IP
- 我的世界手机版如何合并存档,换句话说就是把两幅地图合并在一起?
- 种植大豆每亩需要多少种子?
- 我的世界是单机游戏吗(我的世界还是单机游戏吗)
- 我的世界陷阱制作大全(我的世界陷阱制作大全视频)
- 我的世界小黑(我的世界小黑刷怪塔如何做)
- 我的世界1.5.2星系mod下载(我的世界1.12.2星系mod)
- 寂静岭起源攻略?
- 我的世界动态光源如何安装(我的世界动态光源如何安装不了)
- 我的世界正版皮肤(我的世界正版皮肤加载不出来)
- 我的世界考古与化石(我的世界考古与化石帝鳄如何驯服)
- 我的世界中土大陆(我的世界中土大陆地图还原下载)
- 电脑版我的世界种子(电脑版我的世界种子大全)
- 我的世界npc代码(我的世界npc代码手机版)
- 我的世界苹果版(我的世界苹果版国际版)
- 葫芦侠我的世界如何联机(手机版我的世界联机侠)
- 我的世界东方懒人包(我的世界懒人包如何用)
- 为啥我的win7系统更新到win10之后就特别卡,之前win7玩游戏都很流畅?
- 网易我的世界如何把附魔弄到书上?